Vol04 Tab02
Vol04 Tab02
Vol04 Tab02
2.1 Introduction
Series G Circuit Breakers
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-2 2
Typical Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-2
Eaton Molded Case Circuit Breakers in Assemblies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-3 2
2.2 Series G
Globally Accepted Breakers 2
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-4
Product Selection Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-6 2
Product Selection Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-7
Technical Data and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-9 2
Dimensions and Weights. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-14
EG-Frame (15125 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
JG-Frame (63250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-15
V4-T2-29 2
LG-Frame (250630 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-47
NG-Frame (3201200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-65 2
RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-74
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-85
V4-T2-89
2
30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-96 2
High Instantaneous Circuit Breaker for Selective Coordination . . . . . . . V4-T2-101
Special Features and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-104 2
Motor Operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-112
Plug-In Blocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Drawout Cassette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-114
V4-T2-115
2
2.3 Series C 2
North American Standards and Special Application Breakers
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-116 2
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-117
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-118
V4-T2-121
2
F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-135
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-153 2
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-161
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-185 2
M-Frame (300800 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-211
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-222
V4-T2-237 2
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-256
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-267 2
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-269
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-270
V4-T2-273
2
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-306
2
2.4 Definite Purpose
Optimized Solution for HVAC/R and Pumping Applications 2
Definite Purpose Molded Case Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-333
2.5 Metering and Communications 2
Power Monitoring and Metering with Modbus RTU
PM3 Monitoring and Metering Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-340 2
2.6 Specialty
Specialty Breakers 2
Engine Generator Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-343
Direct Current Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-349 2
PVGard Solar Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-363
E2 Mining Service Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-376 2
Classic Mining Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-402
Add-On Ground Fault ProtectionType GFR. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-416
2
2.7 Handle Mechanisms
Handle MechanismsSeries G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle MechanismsSeries C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-419
V4-T2-431
2
Learn Drawings 2
Online Online
2
Contents
2 Series G E-Frame and Series C F-Frame Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Description Page
2 Introduction
Series G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-4
2 Series C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-116
Definite Purpose . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-333
2 PM3 Monitoring and Metering Module . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-340
Specialty Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-343
2 Learn Drawings
2
Online Online
2
2
2
2
2 Product Overview Application Description
2 Series G vs. Series C Eaton molded case circuit
breakers cover the widest
Feeder Pillars
In distribution systems to
Individual Enclosures
Completely assembled in
Eatons Electrical Sector, range of applications in the
2 under the Eaton brand, offers industry:
provide main and branch
circuit protection.
enclosures to meet specific
customer requirements.
the widest variety of molded
2 case circuit breakers available
today. Designed for electrical
Electrical OEMs
Switchgear Additional Applications
Machinery OEMs
In distribution systems to Special versions of each Eaton
2 and machinery OEMs serving
a range of industries and
Navy breakers: provide main and branch frame are available to provide
applications, these proven
UL 489 Supplement SB circuit protection up to 2500 safe equipment control and
2 designs incorporate the latest MIL-C-17588 amperes (RG-Frame). protection in mining and other
in innovation with the high MIL-C-17361 applications. Contact your
2 reliability that has been our
hallmark since the advent of
ABS/NVR
Busbar Trunking Tap-Offs
In busbar trunking tap-offs to
Eaton agent or distributor for
additional information.
2 Earth leakage
The Series C family ranges Typical Eaton Applications
from 152500 amperes, and
DC breakers 125750 Vdc
2 Engine generator breakers
includes thermal-magnetic
breakers, electronic trip 151200 amperes
Switchboard
2
2
NG 4001600
2
RG 8002500 3
Series C 2
2
FD/ED 15225
JD 70250
KD 70400
2
LD 400600
MDL 300800 2
ND 4001200
RD 8002500 - 2
Notes
1 125 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for EG.
2
2
2 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for LG.
3 1200 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for NG.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Contents
2 Series G, 152500 Amperes for UL, CSA and IEC Applications
Description Page
2 Series G
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-5
2 Product Selection Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-6
V4-T2-7
2 Technical Data and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-9
V4-T2-14
EG-Frame (15125 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-15
2 JG-Frame (63250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-29
LG-Frame (250630 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-47
2 NG-Frame (3201200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-65
RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-74
2 Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-85
V4-T2-89
2 30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module. . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-96
High Instantaneous Circuit Breaker for
2 Selective Coordination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-101
Special Features and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-104
2 Motor Operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-112
Plug-In Blocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-114
2 Drawout Cassette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-115
Learn Drawings
2 Online Online
2
2 Product Overview
Breaker Type
2
Series G frame(s) JG-, LG-, NG- and RG-Frames RG-Frame RG-Frame 2
Ampere rating 202500 A 8002500 A 8002500 A
Interrupting rating at 415 V 35, 70, 100 kA 70, 100 kA 70, 100 kA 2
Trip Unit Sensing
rms sensing Yes Yes Yes
2
Protection and Coordination
2
Protection Ordering options LS, LSG LSI, LSIG LI, LS, LSI, LIG, LSG, LSIG LI, LS, LSI, LIG, LSG, LSIG
Fixed rating plug (In) 1 Yes Yes Yes Yes 2
Overtemperature trip Yes Yes Yes Yes
Long delay Adjustable lr switch Yes Yes No No 2
2
Long delay setting VAR/frame VAR/frame 0.51.0 x (ln) 0.51.0 x (ln)
Long delay time I2t at 6x 10 seconds 2 10 seconds 2 224 seconds 224 seconds
Long delay thermal memory Yes Yes Yes Yes
2
High load alarm 1.05 lr 1.05 lr 0.85 x Ir 0.85 x Ir
Short delay Short delay setting VAR/frame 4 VAR/frame 4 200600% S1 and S2 x (Ir) 200600% S1 and S2 x (Ir) 2
Short delay time I2t 100 ms No 100, 300, 500 ms 100, 300, 500 ms
Short delay time flat No I300 ms 100500 ms 100500 ms 2
Instantaneous
Short delay time ZSI
Independent adjustable Inst. setting
No
No
Yes
Yes 5
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
2
Instantaneous setting No VAR/frame 200600% M1 and M2 x (ln) 200600% M1 and M2 x (ln) 2
Discriminator No No Yes 6 Yes 6
Instantaneous override Yes Yes Yes Yes 2
Ground fault Ground fault setting VAR/Frame 7 VAR/Frame 7 25100% x (ln) 7 25100% x (ln) 7
Ground fault delay I2t at 0.62x No No 100, 300, 500 ms 100, 300, 500 ms
2
Ground fault delay flat I300 ms I300 ms 100500 ms 100500 ms
2
Ground fault ZSI No Yes Yes Yes
Ground fault thermal memory No No Yes Yes 2
Notes
In = Rating plug rating. 2
Ir = Long delay setting.
1
2
310+ trip units have selectable settings instead of a rating plug.
310+ trip units have adjustable long delay times of 224 seconds, except NG 310+ for 800 A frame, for which it is 214 seconds.
2
2
3 310+ details are included by frame in Pages V4-T2-44 (JG), V4-T2-62 (LG), V4-T2-72 (NG), and V4-T2-83 (RG).
4 JG/LG: 2X14X (In); NG: 2X8X (In); RG: 2X9X (In); 2500 ampere RG-Frame 2X6X% x (In).
5 LG, NG and RG ALSI and ALSIG 310+ trip units include an independently adjustable Instantaneous (Ii) setting.
6
7
LS, LSG only. 2
Not to exceed 1200 amperes.
2
2
2
2
JG
2
2
2 RG LG/NG
LS, LSG LSI, LSIG LSI, LSIG, LSIG (A) LSI (A), LSIG
2 System Diagnostics
2 Current
Voltage
Yes 3
No
Yes 3
No
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
2 Field Testing
Testing method Test set 4 Test set 4 Integral Integral
2 Notes
1 Using cause of trip module (catalog number TRIP-LED).
2
4 Test kit available for field testing 310+ trip units (catalog number MTST230V).
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Maximum rated current (amperes) 125, 160 1 250 400, 630 2 2
Breaker type 3 B B E S S H H C E S H C U X E S H C U X
Number of poles 1 2, 3, 4 2, 3, 4 1 2, 3, 4 1 2, 3, 4 3, 4 2, 3, 4 2, 3, 4 2, 3, 4 3, 4 3, 4 3, 4 3, 4 3, 4 3, 4 3, 4 3, 4 3, 4 2
Breaker Capacity (kA rms) Vac 5060 Hz
NEMA, 240 Vac 25 25 35 85 85 100 100 200 65 85 100 200 200 200 65 85 100 200 200 200
2
2
UL, CSA
480 Vac 18 25 35 65 100 25 35 65 100 150 200 35 50 65 100 150 200
600 Vac 4 18 22 25 35 18 18 25 35 50 50 18 25 35 50 65 65
125/250 Vdc 5 10 6 10 10 35 6 35 42 6 42 42 10 22 22 42 50 50 22 22 42 42 50 50 2
IEC 60947-2 220240 Vac Icu 25 25 35 85 85 100 100 200 65 85 100 200 200 200 65 85 100 200 200 200
Ics 25 25 35 43 43 50 50 200 65 85 100 200 200 200 65 85 100 200 200 200
2
380415 Vac Icu
Ics
18 25 40 70 100 25 40 70 100 150 200 35 50 70 100 150 200
2
18 25 30 35 100 25 40 70 100 150 200 35 50 53 100 150 200
660690 Vac Icu 12 12 14 16 18 18 12 20 25 30 35 35 2
Ics 6 6 7 12 14 14 6 10 13 15 18 18
125/250 Vdc 5 Icu 10 6 10 10 35 6 35 42 6 42 42 10 22 22 42 50 50 22 22 42 42 50 50 2
Ics
2
10 6 10 10 35 6 35 42 6 42 42 10 22 22 42 50 50 22 22 42 42 50 50
Ampere range 15160 A 1 20250 A 100630 A 2
Trip Units
F = Fixed
FT-FM
AT-FM
FT-AM
AT-AM
FT-AM
AT-AM
2
A = Adjustable Electronic (Digitrip RMS 310) Electronic (Digitrip RMS 310)
T = Thermal
M = Magnetic
2
Interchangeable
2
Built-in
LSG
LSIG
2
ALSI
ALSIG 2
Utilization category A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A
Notes
2
1 125 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for the EG.
2 630 amperes is not a UL or CSA listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA listed rating for the LG. 2
3 Breaker type C, U and X are current limiting per UL 489.
4 EG breaker rated 600/347 Vac. 2
5 Two poles in series.
6 125 Vdc only for single-pole breakers.
7 Not suitable for DC application. Four-pole ground fault not available.
2
2
Frames NG and RG
2 NG RG
2
2
2
2
Maximum rated current (amperes) 800, 1200 800, 1200 800, 1200 1600 1 800 1600, 2000, 2500 1600, 2000, 2500
2 Breaker type S H C 2 S U H C2
2
Number of poles 2, 3, 4 2, 3, 4 2, 3, 4 3 3 3, 4 3, 4
Breaker Capacity (kA rms) AC 5060 Hz
2 NEMA,
UL, CSA
240 Vac 85 100 200 200 125 200
480 Vac 50 65 100 150 65 100
2 600 Vac 25 35 65 65 50 65
IEC 60947-2 220240 Vac Icu 85 100 200 85 135 200
2 Ics 85 100 100 85 100 100
2 Interchangeable
Built-in
5
2 Electronic 4 LI 6 6
LS
2 LSI
6 6
2
LIG
LSG
2 LSIG
ALSI
2 ALSIG
Utilization category A A A A A A A
2 Notes
2
1 NG 1600 ampere frame is not UL or CSA listed.
2 Not KEMA-KEUR listed.
3 IEC 60947-2 H.5 Annex H is not KEMA-KEUR tested.
2
6 Available only on Digitrip 910 trip units.
2
2
2
2
2
2
NEMA (time constant t = 8 rms) 42 kA max. 42 kA max. 42 kA max. 6 6
Notes
1 125 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for the EG.
2
2
2 630 amperes is not a UL or CSA listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for the LG.
3 1200 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for the NG.
4 Thermal overload release set to the lower value.
5 Thermal overload release set to the upper value.
6 Not suitable for DC switching.
2
2
2
2
2 Solid
Finely stranded with end sleeve
0.75 to 2.5 mm2
0.75 to 2.5 mm2
0.75 to 2.5 mm2
0.75 to 2.5 mm2
0.75 to 2.5 mm2
0.75 to 2.5 mm2
Up to 2x4 mm2
Up to 2x2.5 mm2
Up to 2x4 mm2
Up to 2x2.5 mm2
2 With brought-out cable ends 0.82 (AWG 18) mm2 0.82 (AWG 18) mm2 0.82 (AWG 18) mm2 0.82 (AWG 18) mm2
Tightening torque for fitting screws 0.8 to 1.4 Nm 0.8 to 1.4 Nm 0.8 to 1.4 Nm 0.8 to 1.4 Nm
2 Power loss per circuit breaker at maximum rated
current ln (the power losses of the undervoltage
2 releases (r releases) must be observed if necessary)
at three-phase symmetrical load) 400 A: 600 A:
2
90
90
90
90
2
2 Arc spacing suitable for reverse-feed applications Yes (except HMCPE) Yes Yes Yes Yes
Auxiliary Switches
2 Rated thermal current lth 6A 6A 6A 6A 6A
Rated making capacity 20 A 20 A 20 A 20 A 20 A
2 AC-14 AC-14 AC-14 AC-15 AC-15
2 DC-13 DC-13
Rated operational voltage 125/250V 125/250V 125/250V 125/250V 125/250V
2 Rated operational current 0.5/0.15 A 0.5/0.15 A 0.5/0.15 A 0.5/0.25 A 0.5/0.25 A
2
Backup fuse 6/4/4 A (4) 6/4/4 A (4) 6/4/4 A (4) 6/4/4 A (4) 6/4/4 A
Miniature circuit breaker 6/4 A 6/4 A 6/4 A 6/4 A 6/4 A
2
2
2
2
2
2 EG
H W D
JG
H W D
LG
H W D
2
Three-pole 16.00 (406.0) 8.25 (210.0) 5.50 (140.0) 16.00 (406.0) 15.50 (394.0) 9.75 (229.0)
Four-pole 16.00 (406.0) 11.13 (280.0) 5.50 (140.0) 16.00 (406.0) 20.00 (508.0) 9.75 (229.0)
2
2 Approximate Shipping Weight in Lbs (kg)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 1 Cannot be UL rated.
2 Available only as 125 and 160 A sizes.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
25 EGE2025FFG EGE3025FFG EGE3025AFG EGE4025FFG EGE4025AFG
30 EGE2030FFG EGE3030FFG EGE4030FFG
2 60
63
EGE2060FFG
EGE2063FFG
EGE3060FFG
EGE3063FFG
EGE3063AFG
EGE4060FFG
EGE4063FFG
EGE4063AFG
Notes
2 1 16, 32, 63 and 160 A are not UL listed ratings.
2 Adjustable thermal are not UL listed.
2
3 Change the fourth digit to 7 for 100% neutral protection. Neutral is on the LH side.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Fixed Thermal, Fixed Thermal, Fixed Thermal, Thermal, Fixed Fixed Thermal, Thermal, Fixed
Maximum Fixed Magnetic Fixed Magnetic Fixed Magnetic Magnetic Fixed Magnetic Magnetic
Continuous
Amps at 40 C 1
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
15 EGS1015FFG EGS2015FFG EGS3015FFG EGS4015FFG 2
16 EGS1016FFG EGS2016FFG EGS3016FFG EGS4016FFG
20 EGS1020FFG EGS2020FFG EGS3020FFG EGS4020FFG EGS4020AFG 2
2
25 EGS1025FFG EGS2025FFG EGS3025FFG EGS3025AFG EGS4025FFG EGS4025AFG
30 EGS1030FFG EGS2030FFG EGS3030FFG EGS4030FFG
32 EGS1032FFG EGS2032FFG EGS3032FFG EGS3032AFG EGS4032FFG EGS4032AFG
2
35 EGS1035FFG EGS2035FFG EGS3035FFG EGS4035FFG
40 EGS1040FFG EGS2040FFG EGS3040FFG EGS3040AFG EGS4040FFG EGS4040AFG 2
45 EGS1045FFG EGS2045FFG EGS3045FFG EGS4045FFG
50 EGS1050FFG EGS2050FFG EGS3050FFG EGS3050AFG EGS4050FFG EGS4050AFG 2
60
63
EGS1060FFG
EGS1063FFG
EGS2060FFG
EGS2063FFG
EGS3060FFG
EGS3063FFG
EGS3063AFG
EGS4060FFG
EGS4063FFG
EGS4063AFG
2
70 EGS1070FFG EGS2070FFG EGS3070FFG EGS4070FFG 2
80 EGS1080FFG EGS2080FFG EGS3080FFG EGS3080AFG EGS4080FFG EGS4080AFG
90 EGS1090FFG EGS2090FFG EGS3090FFG EGS4090FFG 2
100 EGS1100FFG EGS2100FFG EGS3100FFG EGS3100AFG EGS4100FFG EGS4100AFG
125 EGS1125FFG EGS2125FFG EGS3125FFG EGS3125AFG EGS4125FFG EGS4125AFG
2
160 EGS3160FFG EGS3160AFG EGS4160FFG EGS4160AFG
2
Notes
1 16, 32, 63 and 160 A are not UL listed ratings.
2 Adjustable thermal are not UL listed.
2
2
3 Change the fourth digit to 7 for 100% neutral protection. Neutral is on the LH side.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
EG-Frame70/65
2 EG-Frame
Single-Pole Two-Pole Three-Pole Four-Pole 3
2
25 EGH1025FFG EGH2025FFG EGH3025FFG EGH3025AFG EGH4025FFG EGH4025AFG
30 EGH1030FFG EGH2030FFG EGH3030FFG EGH4030FFG
2 60
63
EGH1060FFG
EGH1063FFG
EGH2060FFG
EGH2063FFG
EGH3060FFG
EGH3063FFG
EGH3063AFG
EGH4060FFG
EGH4063FFG
EGH4063AFG
2 Notes
1 16, 32, 63A are not UL listed ratings.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 16, 32, 63A are not UL listed ratings.
2 Adjustable thermal is not UL listed.
2
2
3 Change the fourth digit to 7 for 100%
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
EG Bolt-On Complete Breaker (Includes Frame, Trip Unit and Mounting Hardware)
2
EG-Frame18 kAIC at 480 Vac
2 EG-Frame
Single-Pole Two-Pole Three-Pole
2 Maximum Fixed Thermal, Fixed Magnetic Fixed Thermal, Fixed Magnetic Fixed Thermal, Fixed Magnetic
Continuous Catalog Catalog Catalog
Amps at 40 C Number 1 Number 2 Number 3
2 15 EGB1015FFB EGB2015FFB EGB3015FFB
2 20
25
EGB1020FFB
EGB1025FFB
EGB2020FFB
EGB2025FFB
EGB3020FFB
EGB3025FFB
2
110 EGB1110FFB EGB2110FFB EGB3110FFB
125 EGB1125FFB EGB2125FFB EGB3125FFB
2
2 EG-Frame EG-Frame35 kAIC at 480 Vac
Single-Pole Two-Pole Three-Pole
2 Maximum
Continuous
Fixed Thermal, Fixed Magnetic
Catalog
Fixed Thermal, Fixed Magnetic
Catalog
Fixed Thermal, Fixed Magnetic
Catalog
2
Amps at 40 C Number 1 Number 2 Number 3
15 EGS1015FFB EGS2015FFB EGS3015FFB
2
90 EGS1090FFB EGS2090FFB EGS3090FFB
100 EGS1100FFB EGS2100FFB EGS3100FFB
2 2 For bulk pack 12, add suffix BP12 and order quantities of 12.
3 For bulk pack 8, add suffix BP8 and order quantities of 8.
2
2
2
2
EF2RTDK, Two-PoleImperial
2 EF3RTDK, Three-PoleImperial
EF4RTDK, Four-PoleImperial
2
2 Line and Load Terminals
(Package of
2 Maximum
Breaker
Terminal
Body Metric Wire AWG Wire
Three Terminals)
Catalog
Amps Material Wire Type Range mm2 Range Number
2 Standard Cu/Al Pressure Type Terminals
2 125
125
Steel
Steel
Al
Cu
46
2.595
#14-3/0
#14-3/0
3T125EF 1
3T125EF 1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Accessories
2
Allowable Accessory Combinations
2 Different combinations of accessories can be supplied, depending on the types of accessories
and the number of poles in the circuit breaker.
2 EG-Frame Accessories
2 Reference
Single-
Pole Two-Pole Three-Pole Four-Pole
2
Description Page Center Left Right Left Center Right Left Center Right Neutral
Internal Accessories
(Only one internal accessory per pole)
2 Alarm lockout (Make/Break) V4-T2-109
2 Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
2 Accessory available/modification available
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
0.14 (3.6) R
Breaker
1.85
(47.0)
2
0.90 5.50
2
3.03
(22.9) CL (77.0) (139.7)
Handle
1.30 Dia.
(33.0)
0.47 (11.9)
0.94 (23.9)
3.00 2.77 2
(76.2) (70.4)
Notes 2
1 DC ratings apply to substantially non-inductive circuits.
2 IEC only.
3 Two-pole circuit breaker, or two poles of three-pole circuit breaker.
2
2
4 Time constant is 3 milliseconds minimum at 10 kA and 8 milliseconds minimum at 42 kA.
5 Current limiting per UL 489.
2
2
2 1.00
3-Pole
2.98
(25.4) (75.7)
2 1.50 0.50
2.00
(50.8)
2
(38.1) (12.7)
2 4.78
(121.4) 0.70 (17.8)
8.59
2 (218.2)
0.90 (22.9)
2 0.35 (8.9)
2
3.01
2 0.09
(2.29)
(76.5)
3.17
2.75 (80.5)
2 (69.9)
0.78
2 (19.8)
2 4.17
9.66
(245.4)
(105.9)
2
0.56
(14.2) 3.61
(91.7)
2
2 1.00
(25.4)
2 3.00
0.50
1.00 (12.7)
(76.2) (25.4)
2 1.00
(25.4)
2
2 3.20
(81.3)
2 4.17
(105.9)
2
2
2 2.75 0.09
(69.9) (2.3)
2
0.78
2 (19.8)
0.41
2 (10.4)
2 Trip Unit
2 JT 4 100 FA B20
2
Trip Features (ETU Only) 12
2 JT
2 = Two
Number of Poles
Amperes
Trip Unit
AA = Adj. adj.
Blank= No feature
B20 = High load alarm
2
3 = Three T/M ETU FA = Fixed adj. B21 = Ground fault alarm, with trip
4 = FourNeutral 0% Protected 080 050 KS = Molded case switch B22 = Ground fault alarm, no trip
9 = FourNeutral 100% Protected 090 100 33 = 310+ electronic LS ZG = Zone selective interlocking
2 100
110
160
250
32 = 310+ electronic LSI
35 = 310+ electronic LSG
36 = 310+ electronic LSIG
2
125
150
160
2 175
200
225
2 250
2
Notes
1 Bxx features cannot be combined with other Bxx features.
2 B21 and B22 available with LSG and LSIG trip units.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes 2
1 EC-EN 60947-2 only. Adjustment is 0.8 and 1.0.
2 9 for 0100% neutral protection. Neutral is on LH side.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
JG-FrameIEC/CE/UL/CSA70/65
2 JG-Frame
Two-Pole Three-Pole Four-Pole 0%2
2 Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Thermal, Adjustable Adjustable Thermal,
Magnetic Magnetic Fixed Magnetic 1 Magnetic Fixed Magnetic 1
Maximum
2 Continuous
Amperes
Magnetic
Range
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
125 6251250 JGH2125FAG JGH3125FAG JGH3125AAG JGH4125FAG JGH4125AAG
150 7501550 JGH2150FAG JGH3150FAG JGH4150FAG
2 Notes
1 EC-EN 60947-2 only. Adjustment is 0.8 and 1.0.
2
2 9 for 0100% neutral protection. Neutral is on LH side.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
2
2
1 EC-EN 60947-2 only. Adjustment is 0.8 and 1.0.
2 9 for 0100% neutral protection. Neutral is on LH side.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 Maximum
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 1
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 1
Continuous Magnetic Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
2 Amperes Range Number Number Number Number
70 350700 JGX3070FAG JGX4070FAG
2 80 400800 JGX3080AAG JGX4080AAG
2 90
100
450900
5001000
JGX3090FAG
JGX3100FAG
JGX3100AAG
JGX4090FAG
JGX4100FAG
JGX4100AAG
2
2 Molded Case Switches 3
Catalog
2 Number
JGK3250KSG
2 JGK7250KSG
Notes
2 1 EC-EN 60947-2 only. Adjustment is
2
2500 amperes.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
25/25 100% Rated Per UL 489
250 JGE3250NNC
40/35 100% Rated Per UL 489 2
2
250 JGS3250NNC
70/65 100% Rated Per UL 489 2 2
250 JGH3250NNC
2
Thermal-Magnetic Trip Unit 2
Ampere Catalog Catalog
Rating Range Number Range Number 2
70 350700 JT2070FA JT3070FA JT4070FA
80 400800 JT3080FA JT3080AA 3 64100 JT4080AA 3
2
90 450900 JT2090FA JT3090FA JT4090FA
2
100 5001000 JT2100FA JT3100FA JT3100AA 3 80100 JT4100FA JT4100AA 3
125 6251250 JT2125FA JT3125FA JT3125AA 3 100125 JT4125FA JT4125AA 3 2
150 7501550 JT2150FA JT3150FA JT4150FA
160 8001600 JT3160AA 3 128160 JT4160AA 3 2
2
175 8751750 JT2175FA JT3175FA JT4175FA
200 10002000 JT2200FA JT3200FA JT3200AA 3 160200 JT4200FA JT4200AA 3
225 11252250 JT2225FA JT3225FA JT4225FA
2
250 12502500 JT2250FA JT3250FA JT3250AA 3 200250 JT4250FA JT4250AA 3
Notes 2
1 Standard line and load terminals.
2 Components100% rated frame.
3 Adjustable thermal trip units are typically used in IEC markets and are not UL or CSA listed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
250 JT425033 JT425032 JT425035 JT425036
2 Description
Catalog
Number
2
External neutral sensor (80 A) JGFCT050
Breaker-mount cause-of-trip indication TRIP-LED
2 neutral is required.
2 Neutral protection 4 = 0%, 7 = 100% electronic trip unit neutral protection is
2 not adjustable.
3 Four-pole breakers with LSG and LSIG trip units are only available with 0% neutral protection.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
IEC/UL/CSA40/35 2
LS LSI LSG LSIG
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 1 2
Ampere Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
Rating Number Number Number Number Number 2
Three-Pole
50 JGS305033G JGS305032G JGS305035G JGS305036G JGFCT050 2
100
160
JGS310033G
JGS316033G
JGS310032G
JGS316032G
JGS310035G
JGS316035G
JGS310036G
JGS316036G
JGFCT100
JGFCT160
2
250 JGS325033G JGS325032G JGS325035G JGS325036G JGFCT250 2
Four-Pole 23
2
50 JGC305033G JGC305032G JGC305035G JGC305036G JGFCT050
100 JGC310033G JGC310032G JGC310035G JGC310036G JGFCT100
2 160
250
JGC416033G
JGC435033G
JGC416032G
JGC425032G
JGC416035G
JGC425035G
JGC416036G
JGC425036G
2
2 IEC/UL/CSA150/150, Current Limiting Per UL 489
Neutral CT for
2 Ampere
LS
Catalog
LSI
Catalog
LSG
Catalog
LSIG
Catalog
LSG and LSIG 1
Catalog
Rating Number Number Number Number Number
2 Three-Pole
2
50 JGU405033G JGU405032G JGU405035G JGU405036G
100 JGU410033G JGU410032G JGU410035G JGU410036G
2
250 JGX325033G JGX325032G JGX325035G JGX325036G JGFCT250
Four-Pole 2
2
1 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is required.
2 Neutral protection 4 = 0%, 7 = 100% electronic trip unit neutral protection is not adjustable.
3 Four-pole breakers with LSG and LSIG trip units are only available with 0% neutral protection.
2
2
2 IEC/UL/CSA25/25
Neutral CT for
2 LS LSI LSG LSIG LSG and LSIG 1
Ampere Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
2 Rating Number Number Number Number Number
50 JGE305033GC JGE305032GC JGE305035GC JGE305036GC JGFCT050
2 100 JGE310033GC JGE310032GC JGE310035GC JGE310036GC JGFCT100
160 JGE316033GC JGE316032GC JGE316035GC JGE316036GC JGFCT160
2 250 JGE325033GC JGE325032GC JGE325035GC JGE325036GC JGFCT250
2
2 IEC/UL/CSA40/35
Neutral CT for
2
LS LSI LSG LSIG LSG and LSIG 1
Ampere Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
Rating Number Number Number Number Number
2 50 JGS305033GC JGS305032GC JGS305035GC JGS305036GC JGFCT050
2 100
160
JGS310033GC
JGS316033GC
JGS310032GC
JGS316032GC
JGS310035GC
JGS316035GC
JGS310036GC
JGS316036GC
JGFCT100
JGFCT160
2
IEC/UL/CSA70/65
2 LS LSI LSG LSIG
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 1
2 Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
1 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is required.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
250 Aluminum Cu/Al 10185 #8350 (1) TA250FJ 12 Location Number of Poles Catalog Number
4 FJ4RTWK FJ4RTDK
2
Multiwire Connectors
Endcap kits are used on J250-Frame breaker to connect busbar Field-installed multiwire connectors for the load side (OFF) end 2
or similar electrical connections. Includes hardware. terminals are used to distribute the load from the circuit breaker
to multiple devices without the use of separate distribution
terminal blocks.
2
Control Wire Terminal Kit
Catalog
Multiwire lug kits include terminal shield, mounting hardware, 2
Description Number insulators and tin-plated aluminum connectors to replace
Package of 14 (priced individually) FJCWTK
three mechanical load lugs. UL listed as used on the load
side (OFF) end.
2
For use with aluminum or copper terminals only.
JG-Frame Multiwire Connectors Ordering Information
2
Rear Fed Terminals (Package of 3)
Maximum Wires per Wire Size Kit Catalog
2
Maximum Wire Size Catalog
2
Amperes Terminal Range AWG Cu Number
Amperes Range AWG Cu Number
250 3 142 3TA250FJ3
250 #4350 kcmil TA250JGRF
3TA250JGRF
250 6 146 3TA250FJ6 2
Notes
Rear fed terminals allow the cable to connect to the breaker 1 Individually packed. 2
from the back instead of the top. Terminal shields or interphase 2 Standard line and load.
barriers are included with each rear fed terminal kit (depending
on frame size). When catalog number starts with a 3, it indicates
3 Individually priced.
2
a kit with three terminals in each kit. Catalog number beginning
with a TA indicates one terminal. 2
2
2
Accessories
2
Allowable Accessory Combinations
2 Different combinations of accessories can be supplied, depending on the types of accessories
and the number of poles in the circuit breaker.
2 JG-Frame Accessories
2 Description
Reference
Page
Two- and Three-Pole
Left Center Right
Four-Pole
Left Center Right Neutral
2 Internal Accessories
(Only one internal accessory per pole)
2 Electrical operator
Plug-in adapters
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-107
2 Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
2 Accessory available/modification available
2 Note
1 Contact Eaton.
2
2
2
2
2
2 310+ Settings
Ir = continuous current or long delay pickup (amperes) Ir
50 A 100 A 160 A 250 A
2 (All 310+)
A 20 40 63 100
B 20 45 80 125
2 C 25 50 90 150
2
D 30 63 100 160
E 32 70 110 175
2 F 40 80 125 200
G 45 90 150 225
2 H (= In) 50 100 160 250
tr = long delay time (seconds) Position 1 2 2 2 2
2 (All 310+)
Position 2 4 4 4 4
2 Position 3
Position 4
7
10
7
10
7
10
7
10
2 Position 5 12 12 12 12
Position 6 15 15 15 15
2 Position 7 20 20 20 20
Position 8 24 24 24 24
2 Isd (x Ir) = short delay pickup Position 1 2x 2x 2x 2x
(All 310+)
2 Position 2
Position 3
3x
4x
3x
4x
3x
4x
3x
4x
2 Position 4 5x 5x 5x 5x
Position 5 6x 6x 6x 6x
2 Position 6 7x 7x 7x 7x
2
Position 7 8x 8x 8x 8x
Position 8 10x 10x 10x 10x
2 (LSI, LSIG)
Position 2 120 120 120 120
Position 3 300 300 300 300
2 Ig = gound fault pickup (amperes) Position 1 10 20 32 50
(LSG, LSIG)
2
Position 2 15 30 48 75
Position 3 20 40 64 100
2 Position 4 30 60 96 150
Position 5 40 80 128 200
2 Position 6 50 100 160 250
tg = ground fault delay time (milliseconds) Position 1 Inst Inst Inst Inst
2 (LSG, LSIG)
Position 2 120 120 120 120
Notes
2 1 Not available for JG. Independently adjustable Ii setting available in LG, NG and RG ALSI and ALSIG trip units.
2 Maintenance Mode not available for JG frames. It is available for KD, LD, MDL, LG, NG, and RG.
2
2
2
JG-Frame
2
Number
of Poles Width Height Depth
2
2, 3 4.13 (104.9) 7.00 (177.8) 3.57 (90.7)
2
4 5.34 (135.6) 7.00 (177.8) 3.57 (90.7)
2
JG-Frame
2
Front Cover Cutout Front View Three-Pole Side View
CL
Breaker
2
1.25 (31.8)
0.63 (16.0)
0.28 (7.1) 0.19 (4.8) R 3.95
(100.3)
2
2
3.06 2.05 (52.1) 7.00
(77.7) CL (177.8)
Handle
0.50
(12.7) 4.00
1.06 (27.0) 2
(101.6)
4.13
(104.9)
3.44
(87.4) 2
2
Approximate Shipping Weight in Lbs (kg)
2
JG-Frame
Number of Poles 2
Breaker Type 2, 3 4
JGC 6.00 (2.70) 8.00 (3.60) 2
2
JGE 6.00 (2.70) 8.00 (3.60)
JGH 6.00 (2.70) 8.00 (3.60)
JGS 6.00 (2.70) 8.00 (3.60)
2
JGU 6.00 (2.70) 8.00 (3.60)
JGX 6.00 (2.70) 8.00 (3.60) 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 R 0.19
1.88
(47.8) 6.97
3.92 5.50 3.92 (4.8) (177.0)
2 11.25
(285.8)
0.50
(139.7)
1.06
(26.9)
2
2 RESET
4.25
3.37
(85.6)
(108.0)
2
TEST
2
2.05
2 3.31
(84.1) 3.69
3.57
(90.7)
(52.1)
4.09
(93.7) (103.9)
2
3.81
4.78 (96.8)
(121.4)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 Trip Unit
2 LT 3 600 FA B20
2
Trip Features (ETU Only) 12
2 LT Number of Poles Trip Unit Blank= No feature
B20 = High load alarm
3 = Three Amperes AA = Adj. adj., thermal-magnetic
2 4 = Fourneutral 0% protected 250 FA = Fixed adj., thermal-magnetic B21 = Ground fault alarm, with trip
8 = Fourneutral 0/60% protected 300 KS = Molded case switch B22 = Ground fault alarm, no trip
9 = Fourneutral 0/100% protected 350 33 = 310+ electronic LS ZG = Zone selective interlocking
2 400
500
32 = 310+ electronic LSI
35 = 310+ electronic LSG
2
600 36 = 310+ electronic LSIG
630 38 = 310+ electronic ALSI
39 = 310+ electronic ALSIG
2 Notes
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes 2
1 Replace suffix G with W for no line and load terminals.
2 For two-pole applications, use two outer poles.
3 Neutral protection is indicated by the fourth character: 4 = 0%, 7 = 100%, 8 = adjustable 060% and 9 = 0100%. Neutral is on LH side.
2
4 320/630 amperes is not a UL or CSA listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for the LG.
5 Adjustable thermal units are typically used in IEC markets and are not UL or CSA listed.
2
Complete Breaker (Includes Frame, Trip Unit, Standard Terminals and Mounting Hardware)
2
LG-Frame630 Amperes (600 Amperes UL, CSA), Current Limiting Per UL 489
2 LG-Frame
IC Rating: 100 kAIC at 415 and 480 Vac 1
2
Three-Pole 2 Four-Pole (0%) 3
Fixed Thermal, Adjustable Thermal, Fixed Thermal, Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic Adjustable Magnetic 45 Adjustable Magnetic Adjustable Magnetic 45
2 Ampere Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
Rating Number Number Number Number
2 250 LGC3250FAG LGC3250AAG LGC4250FAG LGC4250AAG
300 LGC3300FAG LGC4300FAG
2 320 LGC3320AAG LGC4320AAG
2 350
400
LGC3350FAG
LGC3400FAG
LGC3400AAG
LGC4350FAG
LGC4400FAG
LGC4400AAG
2
LG-Frame630 Amperes (600 Amperes UL, CSA), Current Limiting Per UL 489
2
LG-Frame
IC Rating: 150 kAIC at 415 and 480 Vac 1
Three-Pole 2 Four-Pole (0%) 3
2 Fixed Thermal, Adjustable Thermal, Fixed Thermal, Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic Adjustable Magnetic 45 Adjustable Magnetic Adjustable Magnetic 45
2 Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
350 LGU3350FAG LGU4350FAG
400 LGU3400FAG LGU3400AAG LGU4400FAG LGU4400AAG
2
LG-Frame630 Amperes (600 Amperes UL, CSA), Current Limiting Per UL 489
2
LG-Frame
IC Rating: 200 kAIC at 415 and 480 Vac 1
Three-Pole 2 Four-Pole (0%) 3
2 Fixed Thermal, Adjustable Thermal, Fixed Thermal, Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic Adjustable Magnetic 45 Adjustable Magnetic Adjustable Magnetic 45
2 Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
350 LGX3350FAG LGX4350FAG
400 LGX3400FAG LGX3400AAG LGX4400FAG LGX4400AAG
2
Notes
1 Replace suffix G with W for no line and load terminals.
2 For two-pole applications, use two outer poles.
2 3 Neutral protection is indicated by the fourth character: 4 = 0%, 7 = 100%, 8 = adjustable 060% and 9 = 0100%. Neutral is on LH side.
4 320/630 amperes is not a UL or CSA listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for the LG.
2 5 Adjustable thermal units are typically used in IEC markets and are not UL or CSA listed.
2 Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2 Three-Pole
250 LT325033 LT325032 LT325035 LT325036 LGFCT250
2 400 LT340033 LT340032 LT340035 LT340036 LGFCT400
600 LT360033 LT360032 LT360035 LT360036 LGFCT600
2 630 2 LT363033 LT363032 LT363035 LT363036 LGFCT600
2 Four-Pole 34
250 LT425033 LT425032 LT425035 LT425036
2
310+ Electronic Trip Unit Accessories
2 Catalog
Description Number
2 Electronic portable test kit MTST230V
Notes
2 1 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired.
2 630 amperes is not a UL or CSA listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA listed rating for the LG.
2
3 Neutral protection: 4= 0%, 6 = 60%, 7 = 100%. Electronic trip unit neutral protection is not adjustable.
4 Four-pole LSG and LSIG trip units are only available with 0% neutral protection.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Ampere
LS
Catalog
LSI
Catalog
LSG
Catalog
LSIG
Catalog
for LSG and LSIG 2
Catalog
2
2
Rating Number Number Number Number Number
Three-Pole 3
250 LGE325033G LGE325032G LGE325035G LGE325036G LGFCT250
2
400 LGE340033G LGE340032G LGE340035G LGE340036G LGFCT400
600 LGE360033G LGE360032G LGE360035G LGE360036G LGFCT600 2
630 4 LGE363033G LGE363032G LGE363035G LGE363036G LGFCT600
Four-Pole 5 2
250 LGE425033G LGE425032G LGE425035G LGE425036G
400 LGE440033G LGE440032G LGE440035G LGE440036G 2
2
600 LGE460033G LGE460032G LGE460035G LGE460036G
630 4 LGE463033G LGE463032G LGE463035G LGE463036G
2
Four-Pole
250 LGH425033G LGH425032G LGH425035G LGH425036G
400
600
LGH440033G
LGH460033G
LGH440032G
LGH460032G
LGH440035G
LGH460035G
LGH440036G
LGH460036G
2
630 4 LGH463033G LGH463032G LGH463035G LGH463036G
2
Notes
1 Replace suffix G with W for no line and load terminals.
2 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired.
2
3 For two-pole applications, use two outer poles.
4 630 amperes is not a UL or CSA listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA listed rating for the LG.
2
2
5 Neutral protection: 4= 0%, 6 = 60%, 7 = 100%. Electronic trip unit neutral protection is not adjustable.
6 Four-pole breakers with LSG and LSIG trip units are only available with 0% neutral protection.
IC Rating at 415/480 V
2 Complete LG Breakers with Electronic Trip Unit (Includes Frame, Trip Unit, Standard Terminals and
Mounting Hardware) 1
2 See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-62.
2 IC Rating: 100 kAIC at 415 Vac and 480 Vac, Current Limiting Per UL 489
Neutral CT
2 Ampere
LS
Catalog
LSI
Catalog
LSG
Catalog
LSIG
Catalog
for LSG and LSIG 2
Catalog
2
Rating Number Number Number Number Number
Three-Pole 3
2
600 LGC460033G LGC460032G LGC460035G LGC460036G
630 4 LGC463033G LGC463032G LGC463035G LGC463036G
2 IC Rating: 150 kAIC at 415 Vac and 480 Vac, Current Limiting Per UL 489
2 400
600
LGU340033G
LGU360033G
LGU340032G
LGU360032G
LGU340035G
LGU360035G
LGU340036G
LGU360036G
LGFCT400
LGFCT600
2 Three-Pole 3
250 LGX325033G LGX325032G LGX325035G LGX325036G LGFCT250
2 400 LGX340033G LGX340032G LGX340035G LGX340036G LGFCT400
600 LGX360033G LGX360032G LGX360035G LGX360036G LGFCT600
2 630 4 LGX363033G LGX363032G LGX363035G LGX363036G LGFCT600
2
Four-Pole 5
250 LGX425033G LGX425032G LGX425035G LGX425036G
2 400
600
LGX440033G
LGX460033G
LGX440032G
LGX460032G
LGX440035G
LGX460035G
LGX440036G
LGX460036G
Notes
2 1 Replace suffix G with W for no line and load terminals.
2 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired.
2
5 Neutral protection: 4= 0%, 6 = 60%, 7 = 100%. Electronic trip unit neutral protection is not adjustable.
6 Four-pole breakers with LSG and LSIG trip units are only available with 0% neutral protection.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 600
630 2
LGE360033GC
LGE363033GC
LGE360032GC
LGE363032GC
LGE360035GC
LGE363035GC
LGE360036GC
LGE363036GC
LGFCT600
LGFCT600
2
IEC/UL/CSA 50 kAIC at 415 and 480 Vac
2 Neutral CT for
LS LSI LSG LSIG LSG and LSIG 1
2 Ampere Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
Rating Number Number Number Number Number
2 250 LGS325033GC LGS325032GC LGS325035GC LGS325036GC LGFCT250
400 LGS340033GC LGS340032GC LGS340035GC LGS340036GC LGFCT400
2 600 LGS360033GC LGS360032GC LGS360035GC LGS360036GC LGFCT600
2
Neutral CT for
LS LSI LSG LSIG LSG and LSIG 1
Ampere Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
2 Rating Number Number Number Number Number
250 LGH325033GC LGH325032GC LGH325035GC LGH325036GC LGFCT250
2 400 LGH340033GC LGH340032GC LGH340035GC LGH340036GC LGFCT400
2
600 LGH360033GC LGH360032GC LGH360035GC LGH360036GC LGFCT600
630 2 LGH363033GC LGH363032GC LGH363035GC LGH363036GC LGFCT600
2 Notes
1 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is required.
2 2 630 amperes is not a UL or CSA listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA listed rating for the LG.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
End Cap Kits (MIO Metric Nuts) 630 2500 (2) kcmil TA632LKRF
2 Number
of Poles
Catalog
Number
630 2500 (2) kcmil 3TA632LKRF
2 Handle Extension
2 Standard terminal included with complete breaker.
3 Included in TA63IL, T63IL, TA632L kits listed above.
2 Description
Catalog
Number
Accessories
2
2 Base Mounting Hardware
Base mounting hardware is included with a circuit breaker or molded case switch.
2 (Included with breaker.) If required separately, order 66A4560G03.
2 LG-Frame Accessories
Three-Pole Four-Pole
2
Reference
Description Page Left Center Right Left Center Right Neu.
2
Internal Accessories (Only One Internal Accessory Per Pole)
Alarm lockout (Make/Break) V4-T2-109
2 External Accessories
End cap kit V4-T2-58
2 Handle extension V4-T2-58
Terminal cover V4-T2-58
2 Rear fed terminals V4-T2-58
2 Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
2 Accessory available/modification available
Note
2 1 Contact Eaton.
2
2
2 310+ Settings
Ir = continuous current or long delay pickup (amperes) Ir
250 A 400 A 600 A
2 (All 310+)
A 100 160 250
B 125 200 300
2 C 150 225 315
2
D 160 250 350
E 175 300 400
2 Position 3
Position 4
7
10
7
10
7
10
2 Position 5 12 12 12
Position 6 15 15 15
2 Position 7 20 20 20
Position 8 24 24 24
2 Isd (x Ir) = short delay pickup Position 1 2x 2x 2x
(All 310+)
2 Position 2
Position 3
3x
4x
3x
4x
3x
4x
2 Position 4 5x 5x 5x
Position 5 6x 6x 6x
2 Position 6 7x 7x 7x
2
Position 7 8x 8x 8x
Position 8 10x 10x 10x
2
(ALSI, ALSIG) 7x, 8x, 10x, 7x, 8x, 10x, 7x, 8x, 10x,
12x 12x 12x
Maintenance Mode (remote) pickup (2.5 x In) 2 Fixed 2.5x
2 (ALSI, ALSIG)
2
Notes
1 50 ms for ALSI and ALSIG trip units.
2 Maintenance Mode is enabled remotely using a 24 Vdc circuit.
2
2
2.00
(80.3) 5.58
(141.7) 2
10.13
2
(50.8) (257.3)
1.92
(48.8)
2.69 5.48 2
(68.3) 5.38 (139.2)
2
(136.7) Three-Pole
2
8.44
2 8.44
(214.4)
10.13
(257.3)
(214.4)
2 15.38
(390.7)
2 13.69
13.68
(347.5)
15.38
2
(347.7) (390.7)
2
2
4-Pole 3.97 4-Pole
2.75 (69.9) (100.8) 2.75 (69.9)
3-Pole 3-Pole 4.30 4-Pole 3-Pole
2 5.48 (139.2)
4-Pole
2.74 (69.6) (109.2)
4.55
7.22 (183.4)
3-Pole
2.74 (69.6)
(115.6)
2
7.22 (183.4) 5.48 (139.2)
5.43
(137.9)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 Performance
Amperes
080 = 800 Trip Unit Terminations 3
at 480 Vac
2
120 = 1200 33 = 310+ Electronic LS M = Metric tapped line/load
S = 50 kAIC
H = 65 kAIC 32 = 310+ Electronic LSI conductors
C = 100 kAIC Poles 35 = 310+ Electronic LSG E = Imperial tapped line/load
2 U = 150 kAIC 1
K = Molded
2 = Two
36 =
38 =
310+ Electronic LSIG
310+ Electronic ALSI with maintenance mode
conductors
3 = Three
39 = 310+ Electronic ALSIG with maintenance mode
2 case switch 4 = Four; neutral 2
0% protected
KS = Molded case switch Feature
Blank = No feature
7 = Four; neutral 2
2 100% protected
9 = Four; neutral 2
B20
B21
=
=
High load alarm
Ground fault alarm, with trip
B22 = Ground fault alarm, no trip
2 0/60/100% adjustable
protection
ZG = Zone selective interlocking
2 Notes
1 800 A only.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Molded Case Switches 789j
2
Ue Maximum 690 Vac
Ampere
Rating Three-Pole
Catalog
Number Four-Pole
Catalog
Number
2
800 MCS with Imperial line and load terminals NGK3080KSE MCS with Imperial line and load terminals NGK4080KSE
2
1200 MCS with Imperial line and load terminals NGK3120KSE MCS with Imperial line and load terminals NGK4120KSE
1250 MCS with Imperial line and load terminals NGK3125KSE MCS with Imperial line and load terminals NGK43125KSE 2
Notes
1 For AC use only. 2
2 NG MCCBs are suitable for 40 C or 50 C applications. Order suffix V3 to eliminate standard 40 C labeling.
3 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired. Sold separately.
4 Neutral 0% protected. NG, neutral in right pole; GN, neutral in left pole.
2
5 Neutral 100% protected (denoted by 7 in digit four); no neutral protection available with LSG or LSIG trip units.
6 Neutral 0%/60%/100% adjustable protection (denoted by 9 in digit four).
2
2
7 Non-UL listed NG 1250 with 1250 ampere trip unit is also available.
8 For AC use only. Molded case switch will trip above 14,000 amperes.
9 For two-pole applications, use outer poles of three-pole molded case switch.
j Add M to above catalog numbers for metric tapped line/load conductors.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Type NGH High Interrupting CapacityUe Max. 690 Vac, 65 kA lcu at 480 Vac or 415 Vac
2 See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-72.
2 Maximum
Continuous
Circuit Breaker Frame Including Digitrip Electronic Trip Unit
2
Ampere
Rating Number Neutral CT
at 40 C 12 of Poles LS LSI LSG LSIG ALSI ALSIG for LSG and LSIG 3
2 800 2 NGH208033E NGH208032E NGH208035E NGH208036E
3 NGH308033E NGH308032E NGH308035E NGH308036E NGH308038E NGH308039E NGFCT120
2 4 NGH408033E NGH408032E NGH408035E 4 NGH408036E 4 NGH408038E NGH408039E 4
2 45
46
NGH708033E
NGH908033E
NGH708032E
NGH908032E
NGH708038E
NGH908038E
2
2 Type NGC Very High CapacityUe Max. 690 Vac, 100 kA lcu at 480 Vac or 415 Vac
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-72.
2 Maximum Circuit Breaker Frame Including Digitrip Electronic Trip Unit
Continuous
2 Ampere
Rating Number Neutral CT
at 40 C 12 of Poles LS LSI LSG LSIG ALSI ALSIG for LSG and LSIG 3
2 800 2 NGC208033E NGC208032E NGC208035E NGC208036E
2 3
4
NGC308033E
NGC408033E
NGC308032E
NGC408032E
NGC308035E
NGC408035E 4
NGC308036E
NGC408036E 4
NGC308038E
NGC408038E
NGC308039E
NGC408039E 4
NGFCT120
2
2 Type NGU Ultra High CapacityUe Max. 600 Vac, 150 kA at 480 Vac
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-72.
2 Maximum Circuit Breaker Frame Including Digitrip Electronic Trip Unit
Continuous
2 Ampere
Rating Number Neutral CT
at 40 C 12 for LSG and LSIG 3
2
of Poles LS LSI LSG LSIG ALSI ALSIG
800 3 NGU308033E NGU308032E NGU308035E NGU308036E NGU308038E NGU308039E NGFCT120
2 Notes
1 For AC use only.
2 2 NG MCCBs are suitable for 40 C or 50 C applications. Order suffix V3 to eliminate standard 40 C labeling.
3 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired. Sold separately.
2
4 Neutral 0% protected. NG, neutral in right pole; GN, neutral in left pole.
5 Neutral 100% protected (denoted by 7 in digit four); no neutral protection available with LSG or LSIG trip units.
6 Neutral 0%/60%/100% adjustable protection (denoted by 9 in digit four).
2
2
2
2
External neutral sensor (1200 A) 2 NGFCT120 Three-pole both ends English 5104A24G02
External neutral sensor (800 A) 2 NGFCT120
Breaker-mount cause-of-trip indication TRIP-LED Keeper Nut
Not required on NG-Frame. Terminals are threaded.
2
Breaker-mount ammeter module DIGIVIEW
Remote-mount ammeter module DIGIVIEWR06 2
Handle Extension
Notes
2
2
1 Single terminals individually packed.
2 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired. Sold separately.
3 Metric hardware included with breaker.
4 Included as standard on 100% rated 1200 A breakers only. 2
2
2
Accessories
2
Allowable Accessory Combinations
2 Different combinations of accessories can be supplied, depending on the types of accessories and the number of poles
in the circuit breaker.
2
NG-Frame Accessories
2 Three-Pole Four-Pole
Reference
2 Description Page Left Center Right Left Center Right Neu.
Internal Accessories (Only One Internal Accessory Per Pole)
2
Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
2 Accessory available/modification available
Note
2 1 Contact Eaton.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 310+ Settings
Ir = continuous current or long delay pickup (amperes) Ir
800 A 1200 A
2 (All 310+)
A 320 500
B 400 600
2 C 450 630
2
D 500 700
E 600 800
2 F 630 900
G 700 1000
2 H (= In) 800 1200
tr = long delay time (seconds) Position 1 2 2
2 (All 310+)
Position 2 4 4
2 Position 3
Position 4
6
8
7
10
2 Position 5 10 12
Position 6 12 15
2 Position 7 14 20
Position 8 14 24
2 Isd (x Ir) = short delay pickup Position 1 2x 2x
(All 310+)
2 Position 2
Position 3
3x
4x
3x
4x
2 Position 4 5x 5x
Position 5 6x 6x
2 Position 6 7x 7x
2
Position 7 8x 8x
Position 8 9x 9x
2 Position 9 9x 9x
tsd = short delay time I2t (milliseconds) Fixed 67 at10x 67 at10x
2 (LS, LSG)
tsd = short delay time flat (milliseconds) Position 1 Inst Inst
2
(ALSI, ALSIG) 8x, 10x, 18x 8x, 10x, 12x
Maintenance Mode (remote) pickup (2.5 x In) Fixed 2.5x 2.5x
(ALSI, ALSIG) 2
2 Notes
2
1 50 ms for ALSI and ALSIG trip units.
2 Maintenance Mode is enabled remotely using a 24 Vdc circuit.
2
2
R .25
9.25
(235.0)
2
(6.4)
2
1.91
16.00
(48.5)
(406.4) 2
3.68
2
1.50 (93.5)
(38.1)
2
3.19
(81.0)
6.38 8.25 5.50
2
(162.1) (209.6) (139.7)
2
Approximate Shipping Weight in Lbs (kg)
2
NG-Frame
2
Complete Breaker
Breaker Type Three-Pole Four-Pole 2
NGS, NGH, NGC 45 (20.4) 58 (26.3)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Contents
2 RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes)
Description Page
2 EG-Frame (15125 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-15
JG-Frame (63250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-29
2 LG-Frame (250630 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NG-Frame (3201200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
2 RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes)
Catalog Number Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-75
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-76
2 Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-81
Technical Data and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-82
2 Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-84
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-85
2 Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . .
30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module. . . . . .
V4-T2-89
V4-T2-92
2 Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . .
High Instantaneous Circuit Breaker for
V4-T2-96
2 Product Description
Eatons RG-Frame circuit
2 breakers are available as
frame (which includes trip
unit), rating plug and
2 terminals
All R-Frame circuit breakers
2 are suitable for reverse
feed use
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Performance
Amperes 2
160 = 1600 Trip Unit Terminations
2
at 480 Vac
200 = 2000 33 = 310+ Electronic LS M = Metric tapped line/load
H = 65 kAIC
250 = 2500 32 = 310+ Electronic LSI conductors
C = 100 kAIC
K = Molded
case switch Poles
35 =
36 =
310+ Electronic LSG
310+ Electronic LSIG
E = Imperial tapped line/load
conductors
2
38 = 310+ Electronic LSI w/ Maintenance Mode W = No terminals
2
3 = Three
39 = 310+ Electronic LSIG w/ Maintenance Mode
4 = Four
KS = Molded case switch
Feature
Blank = No feature 2
B20 = High load alarm
B21
B22
=
=
Ground fault alarm, with trip
Ground fault alarm, no trip 2
ZG = Zone selective interlocking
2
RG 310+ Electronic Trip Unit 2
RT 3 250 39 ZG 2
Type Feature
2
RT
2
Trip Unit Blank = No feature
Amperes B20 = High load alarm
33 =
310+ Electronic LS
160 = 1600 32 =
310+ Electronic LSI B21 = Ground fault alarm, with trip
Poles
3 = Three
200 = 2000
250 = 2500
35
36
=
310+ Electronic LSG
=
310+ Electronic LSIG
B22
ZG
=
=
Ground fault alarm, no trip
Zone selective interlocking
2
38 =
310+ Electronic LSI
w/ Maintenance Mode 2
39 = 310+ Electronic LSIG
w/ Maintenance Mode
2
RG Circuit Breaker with OPTIM 610 and 910 Electronic Trip Unit 2
RGH 3 16 T92 W 2
Type Modification Suffix
2
2
RGH 65K Trip Function R = Ground fault remote
RGC 100K Amperes Digitrip 610 RES trip
16 = 1600 T61 = LI E = 100% protection
Poles 20 = 2000
25 = 2500
T62 = LSI (new design 310)
RES trip unit
2
3 = Three T63 = LS
P = 100% prot. neut.
4 = Four T64 = LIG
T65 = LSG
V3 =
4P RES trip unit
Electronic trip without
2
T66 = LSIG
Digitrip 910
ambient temperature
marked on trip unit 2
T91 = LI W = w/o terms
T92 = LSI
T93 = LS
K = Molded case switch
2
T94 = LIG
T95 = LSG
T96 = LSIG
2
2
Product Selection
2
70 kA at 415 Vac and 65 kA at 480 Vac
2
Type RGH with Digitrip 310+ High Interrupting CapacityUe Maximum 690 Vac, 70 kA Icu at 415 Vac
2 See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-83.
2 Maximum
Continuous
Circuit Breaker Frame Including Digitrip RMS 310+ Electronic Trip Unit with
Adjustable Rating PlugsCatalog Number 2
Ampere
2 Rating
at 40 C 1
Number
of Poles LS LSI LSG 3 LSIG 3 ALSI ALSIG
Neutral CT
for LSG and LSIG 4
2
100 kA at Both 415 Vac and 480 Vac
2
Type RGH with Digitrip 310+ High Interrupting CapacityUe Maximum 690 Vac, 70 kA Icu at 415 Vac
2 See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-83.
2 Maximum
Continuous
Circuit Breaker Frame Including Digitrip RMS 310+ Electronic Trip Unit with
Adjustable Rating PlugsCatalog Number 2
Ampere
2 Rating
at 40 C 1
Number
of Poles LS LSI LSG 35 LSIG 35 ALSI ALSIG 35
2 Notes
1 For SCR application, use 2000 ampere frame.
2
2 Order terminals separately. Mounting hardware not included.
3 Ground fault equipped trip units available with remote indicating panel. Add R to catalog number, for example, RGH316035RW.
4 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired. Sold separately.
2 5 No neutral protection available on four-pole breakers with LSG or LSIG trip units.
6 Unprotected left pole neutral. Add P to catalog number for 100% protected left pole neutral, add E for 60% protected, for example, RGH416033PW, RGH416033EW.
2 RG MCCBs have English threading on line and load conductors. Use suffix M for metric threading.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
RG MCCBs have English threading on line and load conductors. Use suffix M for metric threading. 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
at 40 C of Poles LI LS LSI LIG LSG LSIG Fixed Rating Plug
Long Delay Pickup 0.51.0 x In 0.5I.0n 0.51.0 x In 0.51.0 x In 0.51.0 x In 0.51.0 x In
Long Delay Time 224 Seconds 224 Seconds 224 Seconds 224 Seconds 224 Seconds 224 Seconds
2 Short Time Range
Short Time Delay
26 x Ir
26 x Ir
100500 ms
26 x Ir
100500 ms
26 x Ir
26 x Ir
100500 ms
26 x Ir
100500 ms
2
Instantaneous 26 x M1 and M2 26 x M1 and M2 26 x M1 and M2 26 x M1 and M2
Ground Fault Pickup 0.251.0 x In 2 0.251.0 x In 2 0.251.0 x In 2 Ampere Catalog
Ground Fault Delay 100500 ms 100500 ms 100500 ms Rating Number
2 Type RGH with Digitrip 610 High Interrupting CapacityUe Max. 690 Vac, 70 kA Icu at 415 Vac
1600 3 RGH316T61WP44 RGH316T63WP44 RGH316T62WP44 RGH316T64WP44 RGH316T65WP44 RGH316T66WP44 800 RP6R16A080
2 1000 RP6R16A100
2 1200
1250
RP6R16A120
RP6R16A125
2
1250 RP6R20A125
1600 RP6R20A160
2
1600 3 RGC316T61WP44 RGC316T63WP44 RGC316T62WP44 RGC316T64WP44 RGC316T65WP44 RGC316T66WP44 800 RP6R16A080
1000 RP6R16A100
2 1200 RP6R16A120
1250 RP6R16A125
2 Includes 1600 A rating plug 1600 RP6R16A160
2000 3 RGC320T61WP49 RGC320T63WP49 RGC320T62WP49 RGC320T64WP49 RGC320T65WP49 RGC320T66WP49 1000 RP6R20A100
2 1200 RP6R20A120
2 1250
1600
RP6R20A125
RP6R20A160
2
Includes 2500 A rating plug 2500 RP6R25A250
Notes
2 RG MCCBs have metric threading on line and load conductors. Use RD MCCBs if imperial threading is required.
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
2
2
1 Order terminals separately. Mounting hardware not included.
2 Not to exceed 1200 ampere ground fault pickup.
RG MCCBs have metric threading on line and load conductors. Use RD MCCBs if imperial threading is required.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 1600
1600
Aluminum
Copper
Cu/Al
Cu
Metric
Metric
5001000 (4)
1600 (4)
300500
50300
TA1600RDM 1
T1600RDM 1
Single handle
extension
HEX6
2 2000
Rear Connectors
Aluminum Cu/Al Metric 2600 (6) 35300 TA2000RDM 2
Wire Seal
2 2000
2000
Copper
Copper
Metric
Metric
B2016RDM 1
B2016RDLM 1
The wire seal can be used to
secure the cover on the trip
unit to prevent adjustments
2 2500 Copper Metric B2500RDM 1
after settings are confirmed.
2 Catalog Number
T1600RDM 3
1 Order one per polesingle terminals
individually packed.
(For 1600 A 2 Order one TA2000RD kit per three poles.
2
side or load side of three-pole breaker.
OR 3 For use with 2500 A Frame. Do not order
2 Breaker Line/Load
Conductors
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
External neutral sensor (2000 A) RGFCT200A
External neutral sensor (1600 A) 2 RGFCT160A
Breaker-mount cause-of-trip indication 3
2
Breaker-mount ammeter module DIGIVIEW
Remote-mount ammeter module DIGIVIEWR06 2
2
Notes
1 Contact Eaton.
2 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired. Sold separately.
3 Cause-of-trip indication LEDs integrated in RG 310+ trip units.
2
2
2
2
2 RGH 3, 4 125 65 50
RGC 3, 4 200 100 65
2
2 IEC 947-2 Interrupting Capacity Ratings 1
2 Icu
Ics
135
100
70
50
25
13
2 RGC 3, 4
Icu 200 100 35
2 Ics 100 50 18
2
RG 310+ Specifications
2 Description Specification
2
Arcflash reduction maintenance system (or maintenance mode) Yes
Interchangeable trip unit Yes
2 Thru-cover accessories No
Notes
2 1 Utilization Category A circuit breakers.
2 B2x suffixes cannot be combined with B2x suffixes.
2
2
2
2
Notes
2
2
1 50 ms for ALSI and ALSIG trip units.
2 Maintenance Mode is enabled remotely using a 24 Vdc circuit.
2
2
2 RG-Frame
Number
2 of Poles Width Height Depth
3 15.50 (393.7) 16.00 (406.4) 9.75 (247.7)
2 4 20.00 (508.0) 16.00 (406.4) 9.75 (247.7)
2
CL 2.25 (57.2)
14.50 Breaker
(368.3)
7.25
2 0.16 R
(4.1)
(184.2)
2
8.25
(209.6) .44 R
7.75 (11.2)
5.10 (196.9)
2
(129.5)
CL 16.00 13.00
9.70 (330.2)
(406.4) Tee
(246.4) Handle
2 15.00
(381.0)
Connectors
May Be
Rotated 90
2
6.57
2 4 Holes
0.44 Dia.
(166.9)
13.13
(11.2)
2
(333.5) 15.50 9.00 6.75
(393.7) (228.6) (171.5)
2 RG-Frame
Complete Breaker
2 Breaker Number of Poles
Type Three-Pole Four-Pole
2 1600 Amperes
RGH, RGC 102 (46.3) 135 (61.2)
2 2000 Amperes
2 RGH, RGC
2500 Amperes
102 (46.3) 135 (61.2)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Full Load MCP MCP
Continuous Cam Current Trip Catalog
Amperes Setting Amperes 2 Setting 3 Number
2 3 A 0.69 0.91 9 HMCPE003A0C
B 1.11.3 15
2 C 1.61.7 21
2 D
E
2.02.2
2.32.5
27
30
2 F 2.6 2.8 33
7 A 1.52.0 21 HMCPE007C0C
2 B 2.63.1 35
C 3.73.9 49
2 D 4.85.2 63
2 E 5.35.7 70
F 5.86.1 77
2 15 A 3.44.5 45 HMCPE015E0C
B 5.76.8 75
2 C 8.09.1 105
2
D 10.411.4 135
E 11.512.6 150
2 F 12.713.0 165
30 A 3.99.1 90 HMCPE030H1C
2 B 11.513.7 150
C 16.118.3 210
2 D 20.722.9 270
2 E
F
23.025.2
25.326.1
300
330
2 Notes
1 UL listed for use with Eaton Motor Starters.
2 2 Motor FLA ranges are typical. The corresponding trip setting is at 13 times the minimum FLA value shown.
Where a 13 times setting is required for an intermediate FLA value, alternate cam settings and/or MCP ratings should be used.
2
3 For DC applications, actual trip levels are approximately 40% higher than values shown.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
JG-Frame600 Vac Maximum, 250 Vdc Maximum 1
MCP MCP
2
Continuous
Amperes
Trip Range
(Amperes)
Catalog
Number 2
250 5001000
6251250
HMCPJ250D5L
HMCPJ250F5L
2
7501500 HMCPJ250G5L 2
8751750 HMCPJ250J5L
10002000 HMCPJ250K5L 2
11252250 HMCPJ250L5L
12502500 HMCPJ250W5L
2
Notes
1 UL listed for use with Eaton Motor Starters.
2
2
2 Motor FLA ranges are typical. The corresponding trip setting is at 13 times the minimum FLA value shown.
Where a 13 times setting is required for an intermediate FLA value, alternate cam settings and/or MCP ratings should be used.
3 For DC applications, actual trip levels are approximately 40% higher than values shown.
4 Settings above 10 x I are for special applications. Where the ampere rating of the disconnecting means cannot be
n 2
less than 115% of the motor full load ampere rating.
2
2
2
2
2 17503500
20004000
HMCPL600R6G
HMCPL600X6G
2 22504500 HMCPL600Y6G
25005000 HMCPL600P6G
2 30006000 HMCPL600M6G
2 Notes
1 UL listed for use with Eaton Motor Starters.
2 800 and 1200 ampere, 600 Vac maximum motor circuit protectors are available as Series C HMCP product.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
circuit protection
Overload protection
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
2
JGMP Catalog Numbers
35 kAIC 65 kAIC
2 Continuous Amperes
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2 50
100
JGMPS050G
JGMPS100G
JGMPH050G
JGMPH100G
2 100 40 45 50 63 70 80 90 100
160 63 80 90 100 110 125 150 160
2
LGMP Catalog Numbers
2 50 kAIC 65 kAIC
Catalog Catalog
2 Continuous Amperes Number Number
250 LGMPS250G LGMPH250G
2 400 LGMPS400G LGMPH400G
2
600 LGMPS600G LGMPH600G
630 1 LGMPS630G LGMPH630G
2
2 LGMP FLA le Dial Setting
Continuous Amperes A B C D E F G H
2
630 1 250 300 315 350 400 500 600 630
Notes
2 1 630 amperes is not a UL listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL or CSA for LG breaker.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Breaker Type
2
Breaker Capacity (kA rms) AC 5060 Hz LGMPS LGMPH
IEC 60947-2 220240 Vac I cu 85 100
I cs 85 100 2
380415 Vac I cu 50 70
I cs 50 53 2
660690 Vac I cu 20 25
I cs 10 13
2
NEMA UL 489 240 Vac 85 100
2
480 Vac 50 65
600 Vac 25 35 2
Number of poles 3 3
Ampere range 250630 1 250 630 1 2
Notes
1 630 amperes is not a UL listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL or CSA for LG breaker.
2
For pre-trip alarm option, order Style Number 5721B31G02.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Contents
2 30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Modules
Description Page
2 EG-Frame (15125 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-15
JG-Frame (63250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-29
2 LG-Frame (250630 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NG-Frame (3201200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
2 RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . . V4-T2-89
2 30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-93
2 Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-94
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-96
2 High Instantaneous Circuit Breaker for
Selective Coordination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-101
2 Special Features and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-104
V4-T2-112
Plug-In Blocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-114
2 Clockwise from Left:
JG, LG, EG MCCBs Shown with Drawout Cassette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-115
Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module
2
2 30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module
2 Product Description
Eaton offers three- and four- The module is completely self UL-Rated LG-Frame Earth Leakage Module Faceplate
2 pole 30 mA ground fault contained, including a current
(earth leakage) protection sensor, relay and power
2 modules for Series G E-, J-
and L-frame molded case
supply inside the device.
Current pickup settings are
circuit breakers (MCCBs). selectable from 0.03 to 10
2 Separate UL listed and IEC amperes for all devices,
rated devices are available for except for the UL listed
2 each frame. module, for which settings
are selectable from 0.03 to 30
The modules are bottom
2 mounted and are available for
amperes. Time delays are
also selectable from
each frame circuits up to: Instantaneous to 1.0 second
2 EG: 125 amperes for pickup settings of 0.10
amperes and above. The
2 JG: 150 (UL), 160 (IEC)
current pickup setting of
or 250 amperes 0.03 amperes defaults to an
2 LG: 400, 600 (UL)
Instantaneous time setting
or 630 (IEC) amperes IEC-Rated LG-Frame Earth Leakage Module Faceplate
regardless of the time dials
position.
2
Two alarm contacts are
2 included with each device,
which can be wired externally
for remote indication. Both of
2 these are also indicated by an
LED on the front of the
2 device:
1. 50% pre-trip: alarms
2 when the earth leakage
current reaches 50% of
2 the set pickup setting
value.
2 2. 100% after trip: alarms
when the breaker
2 reaches the set pickup
setting value and the
2 breaker trips.
Dimensions
2 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
2 Frame
Three-Pole
Height Width Depth
2
Four-Pole
EG 10.25 (260.3) 4.00 (101.6) 2.98 (75.8)
2 (260.6)
4.75
(120.6)
0.55 (14.0)
2 1.49
2 0.50
(12.7)
1.00 (37.8)
(25.4)
3.98
(101.1)
2
3-Pole
1.00 2.98
(25.4) (75.7)
2 1.50 0.50
2.00
(50.8)
(38.1) (12.7)
2
2 4.78
(121.4)
8.59 0.70 (17.8)
2 (218.2)
0.90 (22.9)
0.35 (8.9)
2
2 3.01
0.09 (76.5)
2 (2.29)
2.75
3.17
(80.5)
(69.9)
2 0.78
(19.8)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
11.25
(285.8)
0.50
(139.7)
1.06
(26.9)
2
2
4.25
3.37
(85.6)
2
RESET
(108.0)
2
TEST
2
2.05
3.31
(84.1)
3.57
3.69 (90.7)
(52.1)
4.09
2
(93.7) 3.81 (103.9)
4.78 (96.8) 2
(121.4)
2
LG-Frame With Earth Leakage Module
2
5.16 4.31 3.44
(131.1) (109.5)
4.06
(87.4)
1.72
2
3.44
2
(87.4) (103.1) (43.7)
1.72 3.98 0.86
(43.7) (101.1) (21.8)
2
5.58
5.58
4.73
2
4.73 (141.7)
(141.7)
2
(120.1) (120.1)
2
8.44
2
8.44 10.13 (214.4)
(214.4) (257.3)
15.38
(390.7) 2
13.69 15.38
13.68
(347.5) 2
(347.7) (390.7)
2
2
4-Pole 3.97 4-Pole
3-Pole
2.75 (69.9)
3-Pole
(100.8)
4.30 4-Pole
2.75 (69.9)
3-Pole
2
5.48 (139.2) 2.74 (69.6) (109.2) 7.22 (183.4) 2.74 (69.6)
4-Pole 4.55 3-Pole 2
7.22 (183.4) (115.6) 5.48 (139.2)
5.43
(137.9) 2
Contents
2 Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Modules
Description Page
2 EG-Frame (15125 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-15
JG-Frame (63250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-29
2 LG-Frame (250630 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NG-Frame (3201200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
2 RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . . V4-T2-89
2 30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module. . . . . . V4-T2-92
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module
2 Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-97
Technical Data and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-98
2 Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
High Instantaneous Circuit Breaker for
V4-T2-98
2 Selective Coordination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Special Features and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-101
V4-T2-104
Motor Operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-112
2 Plug-In Blocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-114
Drawout Cassette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-115
2
2 Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module
2 Product Overview Product Description Features and Benefits Standards and Certifications
Power demand continues The current limiting breaker Superior system protection: IEC 60947-2
2 to grow in new and existing modules use a unique contact
Auto reset improves
UL 489
facilities. To meet increased design to enhance the CSA C22.2
system uptime and
2 demand, larger utility
supplies, spot networks and
system protection similar to
that of the circuit breaker. eliminates the need for
finding replacement parts
2 large facility transformers
are installed. The increased
When high short-circuit
current is flowing through the No fuses to replace,
capacity of the electrical contacts of these modules, reducing the overall cost of
2 source results in increased the design results in very high ownership and the waste
fault currents in excess interrupting capacities and created by fuses
2 of 100 kA short-circuit
protection. Eaton
improved current limiting
characteristics.
Overloads, by using inverse
time current tripping
2 manufactures non-fused
current limiting modules with Application Description
characteristics of the
molded-case circuit
interrupting capacities up to High-performance breakers breaker
2 200 kA at 600 Vac or 70 kA at are most commonly applied Low-level short circuits, by
690 Vac. Unlike fused current when very high fault levels using instantaneous and/or
2 limiters with a one-time use, are available and with short-time delay tripping
a current limiter module applications where the characteristics of the
2 provides an automatic reset
of the module after a short-
current limiting capability is
used upstream of the final
molded-case circuit
breaker
2 circuit event. Resetting the
molded-case circuit breaker is
load to limit current. Typical
loads include lighting, power
High-level short circuits, by
using ultra-high-speed,
the only action required to distribution, and motor
2 restore critical power to the control applications.
blow-apart contacts of the
current limiting module in
system; there is no time
2 wasted with sourcing the
series with the circuit
breaker contacts
correct replacement fuses
Let-through currents, by
2
or module to bring system
back online. improved opening speed of
the contacts, the resultant
2 rapid rise of arc voltage
introduces impedance into
2 the system
2
2
2
2
Dimensions and Weights
2 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
2 Frame
EG
Height
9.66 (245.7)
Width
3.00 (76.2)
Depth
2.98 (75.8)
Weight in lbs (kg)
2.91 (1.32)
2 4.17
9.66
(245.4)
2 0.56 (105.9)
(14.2) 3.61
(91.7)
2
2
1.00
2 3.00
(25.4) 0.50
1.00 (12.7)
(76.2)
2 1.00
(25.4)
(25.4)
2
2 3.20
(81.3)
2 4.17
(105.9)
2
2
2 2.75 0.09
(69.9) (2.3)
2
0.78
2 (19.8)
2 0.41
(10.4)
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
2
1 Two interphase barriers provided, mounted on line end of limiter, catalog number FJIPBK.
2 Four interphase barriers provided, (2) line end of breaker, (2) load end of limiter. 2
3 Line and load terminals included with products listed above.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Dimensions and Weights
2 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
2
2
2
4.12 4.13
(104.6) (104.9)
2
2
2
13.06
2 (331.7)
2
2
4.41
2 (112.0)
3.44
2 3.34
(84.8)
(87.4)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
Proven Technology
2 and Performance
LHH LHH and NHH Catalog Numbers
The LHH is based on the
2 Series G L-Frame circuit
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit
LSI Electronic
Trip Unit
breaker, sharing the same
Ampere
2 small footprint and field-fit
accessories as the L-Frame
Rating LHH Frame NHH Frame
125 LHH3125FFG
2 breaker. The NHH is based
on the Series G N-Frame 150 LHH3150FFG NHH3150T52X15
circuit breaker and shares
2 the same footprint and
175
200
LHH3175FFG
LHH3200FFG
NHH3175T52X15
NHH3200T52X15
accessories as the N-Frame
2 breaker. NHH accessories
must be factory installed.
225 LHH3225FFG NHH3225T52X15
250 LHH3250FFG NHH3250T52X15
2 The LHH incorporates a 300 LHH3300FFG NHH3300T52X15
thermal-magnetic trip unit 350 LHH3350FFG NHH3350T52X15
2 with fixed thermal and
400 LHH3400FFG
fixed magnetic settings.
2 The NHH has an OPTIM
electronic trip unit with
2 LSI adjustment capabilities.
The instantaneous setting is
adjustable from 10004000 A
2 or may be turned off to
default to the frame override
2 of 14,000 A. A hand-held
OPTIMizer must be used
2 with the NHH to adjust
short-time delay and
instantaneous, however,
2 the long delay pickup is fixed
and cannot be adjusted.
2 The LHH and NHH
2
breakers are available in
Eatons panelboards and
switchboards.
2 Standards and Certifications
2 UL
CSA
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Contents
2 Description Page
2 EG-Frame (15125 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-15
JG-Frame (63250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-29
2 LG-Frame (250630 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NG-Frame (3201200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
2 RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . . V4-T2-89
2 30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module. . . . . . V4-T2-92
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-96
2 High Instantaneous Circuit Breaker for
Selective Coordination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-101
2 Special Features and Accessories
Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-106
2 External Accessories and Test Kit . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-109
Motor Operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-112
2 Plug-In Blocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-114
Drawout Cassette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-115
2
2 Special Features and Accessories
2 Eatons molded case circuit
breakers are designed to
In low voltage distribution
systems, there are many
Special Calibration
Special non-UL listed
Calibrations and Treatment
Frame
provide circuit protection for varied applications of molded
2 low voltage distribution case circuit breakers.
calibrations are available for
certain ambient temperatures
Description EG JG LG NG RG
2 short circuits.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 Number
TRIP-LED
2
2
Notes
2
2
1 Provision only.
2 See Page V4-T2-318 for bolt projection dimensions.
3 Castell bolt mounting hole must be 10 mm.
4 Requires two breakers.
5 Contact Eaton for availability of operators for EG- and NG-Frames before December 2004.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Description Pole Location For Use in Frame Contact Type Catalog Number
Make/Break Right EG Silver ALM1M1BEPK
2
2 Make/ 2 Break
Make/Break
Right
Right
EG
JG and LG
Silver
Silver
ALM2M2BEPK
ALM1M1BJPK
2
2 Make/ 2 Break
Make/Break
Right
Right
JG and LG
EG
Silver
Gold
ALM2M2BJPK
ALM1M1BEEPK
2
2 Make/ 2 Break
Make/Break
Right
Right
EG
JG and LG
Gold
Gold
ALM2M2BEEPK
ALM1M1BEJPK
2
2 Make/ 2 Break Right JG and LG Gold ALM2M2BEJPK
2
Auxiliary Switch
2
Frame
Description Pole Location EG, JG and LG NG RG 1 2
1A, 1B Left A1X5PK
Right AUX1A1BPK A1X5PK 2
2A, 2B Left A2X5PK
Right AUX2A2BPK A2X5PK A2X6RPK 2
3A, 3B Left A3X5LPK
Right A3X5RPK 2
4A, 4B Left
Right A4X6RPK 2
Description Pole Location For Use in Frame Contact Type Catalog Number
2
1A, 1B Right EG/JG/LG Silver AUX1A1BPK 2
2A, 2B Right EG/JG/LG Silver AUX2A2BPK
1A, 1B Right EG/JG/LG Gold AUX1E1BPK 2
2A, 2B Right EG/JG/LG Gold AUX2E2BPK
2
Auxiliary Switch/Alarm Lockout
Frame 2
Description 1
2
Pole Location EG, JG and LG NG RG
Left AA115LPK
2
Right AUXALRMEPK 4 AA115RPK
Description Pole Location For Use in Frame Contact Type Catalog Number 2
1A/1B & 1M/1B Right EG Silver AUXALRMEPK
1A/1B & 1M/1B Right JG and LG Silver AUXALRMJPK 2
1A/1B & 1M/1B Right EG Gold AUXALRMEEPK
1A/1B & 1M/1B Right JG and LG Gold AUXALRMEJPK 2
Notes
1 All accessories mount in the RH cavity which will accept one each of shunt trip, UVR, auxiliary switch and alarm switch. 2
2 Part number for JG and LG is ALM1M1BJPK.
3 Part number for JG and LG is ALM2M2BJPK.
4 Part number for JG and LG is AUXALRMJPK.
2
2
Shunt TripStandard
2 Shunt TripStandard
Frame
Pole
2 ST
Description
4860 Vac
Location
Left
EG, JG and LG 1
SNT4860CPK
NG
SNT5LP05K
RG 2
a
2 110240 Vac
Right
Left
SNT120CPK
SNT5LP11K
SNT6P05K
2 380600 Vac
Right
Left
SNT480CPK 3
SNT6P11K
2
Right
220250 Vdc or 380440 Vac SNT5LP14K SNT6P14K
2
480600 Vac SNT5LP18K SNT6P18K
12 Vdc Left SNT012CPK
Right
2 24 Vac/dc Left SNT024CPK SNT5LP03K
Right SNT6P03K
2 4860 Vdc Left SNT4860CPK SNT5LP23K
Right SNT6P23K
2 110125 Vdc Left SNT125DPK SNT5LP26K
Right SNT6P26K
2 250 Vdc Left SNT250DPK
Right
2
Shunt TripLow Energy
2 Frame
Pole
2
Description Location EG, JG and LG NG RG 2
Left LST5LPK
2 Right LST6RPK
2 Right UVH6RP05K
120 Vdc Left UVR125DPK UVH5LP26K
2 220250 Vdc
Right
Left
UVR250DPK
UVH5LP28K
UVH6RP26K
2 380500 Vac
Right
Left
UVR480APK
UVH5LP29K
UVH6RP28K
2 525600 Vac
Right
Left
UVR600APK
UVH6RP29K
2 12 Vdc
Right
Left
UVH5LP20K
2 12 Vac
Right
Left
UVH5LP02K
UVH6RP20K
2
Right UVH6RP02K
Notes
Contents
2 Series G Motor Operators
Description Page
2 EG-Frame (15125 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-15
JG-Frame (63250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-29
2 LG-Frame (250630 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NG-Frame (3201200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
2 RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . . V4-T2-89
2 30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module. . . . . . V4-T2-92
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-96
2 High Instantaneous Circuit Breaker for
Selective Coordination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-101
2 Special Features and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Operators
V4-T2-104
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
PUSH-TO-TRIP Button 2
2
2
2
Standards and Certifications
The motor operators are UL 2
and CSA listed, and CE
marked. 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Contents
2 LG Breaker with Plug-In Block
Description Page
2 EG-Frame (15125 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-15
JG-Frame (63250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-29
2 LG-Frame (250630 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NG-Frame (3201200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
2 RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . . V4-T2-89
2 30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module. . . . . . V4-T2-92
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-96
2 High Instantaneous Circuit Breaker for
Selective Coordination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-101
2 Special Features and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-104
V4-T2-112
2 Plug-In Blocks
Drawout Cassette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-115
2
2
2 Plug-In Blocks
2 Product Description Product Selection
Plug-in adapters simplify
2 installation and front removal Plug-In Blocks
of circuit breakers. Plug-ins Breaker Number Catalog
2 are available for rear
connection applications on
Frame of Poles Number
EG-, JG- and LG-Frame Plug-In Blocks
2 three- and four-pole circuit
breakers. Trip on drawout EG 3 PAD3E
interlock kits are included.
2
EG 4 PAD4E
Stabs for EG, JG and LG plug-
JG 3 PAD3J
ins rotate 90 for flexible
2 installation. Use terminal
shields for IP30 protection.
JG 4 PAD4J
LG 3 PAD3L
2 LG 4 PAD4L
Trip-On Drawout Interlock Kit 1
2 EG 3, 4 PIILEG
2 JG
LG
3, 4
3, 4
PIILJG
PIILLG
2
JG 3 FJTS3K
JG 4 FJTS4K
2 LG 3 LTS3K
LG 4 LTS4K
2 Note
1 Included with plug-in block. Trips the breaker when breaker is removed from plug-in block.
2
2
2
2
2
Contents
2 Molded Case Circuit Breaker Product Family
Description Page
2 Standards and Certifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-117
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-118
2 G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-121
V4-T2-135
2 J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-153
V4-T2-161
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-185
2 M-Frame (300800 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-211
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-222
2 R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-237
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-256
2 Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB). . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-269
2 Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-270
V4-T2-273
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-306
2 Learn Drawings
Online Online
2
2 Product Overview
2 Eatons molded case circuit
breakers are designed to
Eaton offers the most
comprehensive family of
50 C Calibration
Add suffix V to catalog
These specifications
generally require molded
provide circuit protection for molded case circuit breakers case circuit breakers to be
2 low voltage distribution in the industry.
Number for complete
breaker, listed above, when supplied with 50 C ambient,
systems. They are described ordering listed ampere ratings and plug-in adapter kits.
2 by NEMA as, ... a device for This section of circuit breakers
includes: for breakers to be used in When plug-in adapter kits are
closing and interrupting a 50 C ambients. (No UL label.) used, no terminals need be
2 circuit between separable
contacts under both normal
Thermal-magnetic trip
Moisture-Fungus Treatment
supplied (switchboard
applications).
breakers
2 and abnormal conditions,
and furthermore as, ... a
Electronic rms trip All circuit breaker cases are
molded from glass-polyester
Circuit breakers can also be
breakers supplied to meet UL 489
breaker assembled as an
2
which does not support the
integral unit in a supporting
Molded case switches Supplement SA (Marine use)
growth of fungus. Any parts
and enclosing housing of Motor circuit protectors and UL 489 Supplement SB
which are susceptible to the
2 insulating material. The Current limiting breakers growth of fungus will require
(Naval Use).
National Electrical Code Special application special treatment. UL 489 Supplement SA
2 (NEC) describes them as, A
device designed to open and
breakers
Freeze-Tested Circuit
applies to vessels over 65 feet
(19.8 m) in length.
Modified Breakers Breakers
2 close a circuit by non-
automatic means, and to Eaton breakers can be ordered The circuit breakers may be
Requirements include 40 C
ambient calibration, special
open the circuit automatically ordered with freeze testing.
2
with internal accessories labeling, and no use of
on a predetermined overload installed. These modified This option uses special aluminum conductors or
of current, without injury to breakers will be subject to an lubrication and mechanical terminals. (No 50 C.)
2 itself when properly applied addition charge. operation is verified at 40 C.
Suffix H08
within its rating.
2 So designed, Eaton circuit
Special Calibration
Special non-UL-listed
Marine Applications
E- to R-Framed circuit
Or you can choose to add 50
breakers protect conductors C ambient but then there is
2 against overloads and calibrations are available for
certain ambient temperatures
breakers can be supplied to
meet the following marine
no UL mark.
conductors and connected
other than 40 C and for specifications: Suffix VH08
2 apparatus, such as motors
and motor starters, against frequencies other than 50/60 U.S. Coast Guard CFR 46; UL 489 Supplement SB
Hz or DC. Reduced
2 short circuits.
interrupting ratings will apply ABSAmerican Bureau of
Shipping; IEEE 45; DNV;
requires partial 50 C ambient
calibration, vibration testing,
In low voltage distribution for 400 Hz applications.
Lloyds; and ABS/NVR special nameplating and no
2 systems, there are many
varied applications of molded
use of aluminum conductors
or terminals. Eaton chooses
2 case circuit breakers.
to always fully calibrate to 50
C ambient. (Naval labeled
2 per UL, and UL now allows
50 C label here.)
2 Suffix VH09
breakers
British Standards Institution
requirements 2
Verband Deutscher
Standard BS 4752: Part 1,
switchgear and control Elektrotechniker 2
gear Part 1: circuit breakers (Association of German
Canadian Standards
Electrical Engineers)
Standard VDE 0660, low
2
Association (CSA) Standard
C22.2 No. 5, service
voltage switchgear and
control gear, circuit 2
entrance and branch circuit breakers
breakers 2
International
Electrotechnical
Commission
2
Recommendations IEC
60947-2, circuit breakers
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Quick Reference
2
Industrial Circuit Breakers
2
2 G-Frame
Continuous Volts UL Listed Interrupting Ratings (rms Symmetrical Amperes)
2 Circuit
Breaker
Ampere
Rating No. of Type
Federal
Specification
AC (kA) DC (kA) 2
Page
Type at 40 C Poles AC DC of Trip 1 W-C-375b 120 120/240 240 277 480 600 125 3 250 Number
2 GHB 15100 1 120 125 N.I.T.U. 11a 65 14 V4-T2-126
2 GBHS
GDB
1520
1550
1, 2
2
600Y/347
480
125/250
N.I.T.U.
N.I.T.U.
14
10
10
V4-T1-34
V4-T2-124
Notes
2 1 N.I.T.U. is non-interchangeable trip unit and I.T.U. is interchangeable trip unit.
2 Two-pole circuit breaker, or two poles of three-pole circuit breaker at 250 Vdc.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
J-Frame
2 Continuous Volts UL Listed Interrupting Ratings (rms Symmetrical Amperes)
Circuit Ampere Type Federal
2 Breaker
Type
Rating
at 40 C
No. of
Poles AC DC
of
Trip 1
Specification
W-C-375b
AC (kA)
120 120/240 240 277 480 600
DC (kA) 2
125 250
Page
Number
2 K-Frame
2 Circuit
Continuous
Ampere
Volts
Type Federal
UL Listed Interrupting Ratings (rms Symmetrical Amperes)
AC (kA) DC (kA) 2
Breaker Rating No. of of Specification Page
2 Type at 40 C Poles AC DC Trip 1 W-C-375b 120 120/240 240 277 480 600 125 250 Number
DK 250400 2, 3 240 250 N.I.T.U. 14b 65 10 V4-T2-167
2 KDB 100400 2, 3 600 250 N.I.T.U. 23a 65 35 25 10 V4-T2-167
2
KD 100400 2, 3, 4 600 250 I.T.U. 23a 65 35 25 10 V4-T2-164, V4-T2-165,
V4-T2-169, V4-T2-172
CKD 100400 2, 3, 4 600 250 I.T.U. 23a 65 35 25 V4-T2-166, V4-T2-175,
2 V4-T2-177
HKD 100400 2, 3, 4 600 250 I.T.U. 23a 100 65 35 22 V4-T2-164, V4-T2-165,
2 V4-T2-169, V4-T2-172
CHKD 100400 2, 3, 4 600 250 I.T.U. 23a 100 65 35 V4-T2-166, V4-T2-175,
2 V4-T2-177
KDC 3 100400 2, 3, 4 600 250 I.T.U. 23a 200 100 65 22 V4-T2-164, V4-T2-165,
2 V4-T2-169, V4-T2-172
2
L-Frame
2 Circuit
Continuous
Ampere
Volts
Type Federal
UL Listed Interrupting Ratings (rms Symmetrical Amperes)
AC (kA) DC (kA) 2
2
Breaker Rating No. of of Specification Page
Type at 40 C Poles AC DC Trip 1 W-C-375b 120 120/240 240 277 480 600 125 250 Number
2
LDB 300600 2, 3 600 250 N.I.T.U. 23a 65 35 25 22 V4-T2-190
LD 300600 2, 3, 4 600 250 I.T.U. 23a 65 35 25 22 V4-T2-188, V4-T2-189,
V4-T2-194
2 CLD 300600 2, 3, 4 600 250 I.T.U. 23a 65 35 25 V4-T2-190, V4-T2-200
2 CHLD
LDC 3
300600
300600
2, 3, 4
2, 3, 4
600
600
250
250
I.T.U.
I.T.U.
23a
23a
100
200
65
100
35
50
30
V4-T2-190, V4-T2-200
V4-T2-188, V4-T2-189,
2
V4-T2-196
CLDC 3 300600 2, 3, 4 600 250 I.T.U. 23a 200 100 50 30 V4-T2-190, V4-T2-202
2
2 M-Frame
Continuous Volts UL Listed Interrupting Ratings (rms Symmetrical Amperes)
2 Circuit
Breaker
Ampere
Rating No. of
Type
of
Federal
Specification
AC (kA) DC (kA) 2
Page
Type at 40 C Poles AC DC Trip 1 W-C-375b 120 120/240 240 277 480 600 125 250 Number
2 MDL 300800 2, 3 600 250 I.T.U. 23a 65 50 25 22 V4-T2-213, V4-T2-215
2
CMDL 300800 2, 3 600 250 I.T.U. 23a 65 50 25 V4-T2-215
HMDL 300800 2, 3 600 250 I.T.U. 23a 100 65 35 25 V4-T2-213, V4-T2-215
Notes
2 1 N.I.T.U. is non-interchangeable trip unit and I.T.U. is interchangeable trip unit.
2 Two-pole circuit breaker, or two poles of three-pole circuit breaker at 250 Vdc.
2 3 Current limiting.
2
2 Technical Data and Specifications
2 GD 2 65 14 10
GD 3 65 22 10
2 GHQ 65 14
GHB 1 65 14 14
2 GHB 2, 3 65 14 14
2 HGHB
GHC
1
1
65
65
25
14
14
14
2 GHC 2, 3 65 14 14
HGHC 1 65 25 14
2 Terminal Types
2 For line and load-side. Terminals are UL listed as suitable for wire type and size given below.
2 Terminal Types
Circuit Breaker Amperes Terminal Type Material Screw Head Type Wire Type AWG Wire Range Metric Wire Range (mm2) 5
2 Standard
2
1520 Clamp (plated steel) Slotted Cu/Al 1410 2.54
25100 Pressure (aluminum body) Slotted Cu/Al 101/0 450
2
2
2
2
2 20
25
GDB2020
GDB2025
GDB3020
GDB3025
2 30 GDB2030 GDB3030
35 GDB2035 GDB3035
2 40 GDB2040 GDB3040
2
45 GDB2045 GDB3045
50 GDB2050 GDB3050
2 60 GDB3060
70 GDB3070
2 80 GDB3080
90 GDB3090
2 100 GDB3100
2 100 GD3100KD 2
Notes
2 1 Includes line and load steel terminals.
2 Includes binding head screws and clamps 1032 x 0.312.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
3.00 2.63
(76.2) (66.7)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Contents
2 Typical GHB
Description Page
2 Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-116
Standards and Certifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-117
2 Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-118
V4-T2-121
2 F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-135
V4-T2-153
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-161
2 L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-185
M-Frame (300800 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-211
2 N-Frame (4001200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-222
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-237
2 Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB). . . . . . . .
V4-T2-256
V4-T2-267
2 Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-269
V4-T2-270
Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-273
2 External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-306
2
2 Types GHB and HGHB Bolt-On Panelboard Circuit Breakers (15100 Amperes)
2 Standards and Certifications
These breakers meet the
2 requirements of Federal
Specification W-C-375b as
2 follows:
Type GHB, 120 and 240 V:
2 Single-pole: Class 11a
Two-, three-pole:
2 Classes 10b, 11b, 12b,
14b, 15b
2 UL/CSA
480Y/277V:
2 Single-pole:
Class 13b
Type HGHB 277V
2 Type GHQ 277V
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
2
1 480Y/277 V, circuit breakers (Type GHB) not suitable for three-phase delta (480 V).
2 Single-pole breakers can be applied in DC systems from 15 through 70 amperes; 80 through 100 amperes devices
2
are not suitable for DC application.
3 Use two outside poles.
4 Uses 0.190 (4.83) 32 screw type clamp terminals.
2
5 Add suffix HID for High Intensity Discharge (HID) applications. 15 and 20 ampere, single-pole are SWD rated.
6 15 and 20 ampere, single-pole are SWD rated.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Dimensions
2 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
2
GDB-Frame, Three-Pole
2 Front View
2 Side View
2
2
2
2 4.00
(101.6)
2
2
2
2 3.00
(76.2)
2.63
(66.7)
2
Max.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Dimensions
2 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
2
GHB-Frame, Three-Pole
2 Front View
2 Side View
2
2
2
2 4.00
(101.6)
2
2
2
2 3.00
(76.2)
2.63
(66.7)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
2 Type GHC Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with
Non-Interchangeable Trip Units
2 277 Vac Maximum, 480Y/277 Vac Maximum, 480Y/277 Vac Maximum,
125 Vdc Maximum 1 125/250 Vdc Maximum 125/250 Vdc Maximum 2
2 Continuous Single-Pole Two-Pole Three-Pole
Ampere Rating Catalog Catalog Catalog
2 at 40 C Number Number Number
15 GHC1015 34 GHC2015 3 GHC3015 3
2 20 GHC1020 34 GHC2020 3 GHC3020 3
2
25 GHC1025 GHC2025 GHC3025
30 GHC1030 GHC2030 GHC3030
2
70 GHC1070 GHC2070 GHC3070
80 GHC1080 GHC2080 GHC3080
2 15 HGHC1015 5
20 HGHC1020 5
2 25 HGHC1025
30 HGHC1030
2 Notes
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Contents
2 Special Purpose Circuit Breakers
Description Page
2 Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-116
Standards and Certifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-117
2 Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-118
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-121
2 F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-135
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-153
2 K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-161
V4-T2-185
2 M-Frame (300800 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-211
V4-T2-222
2 R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-237
V4-T2-256
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB). . . . . . . . V4-T2-267
2 Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . . V4-T2-269
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-270
2 Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-273
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-306
2
2 Special Purpose GHC Circuit Breakers (15100 Amperes)
2 Product Description Product Selection
Eatons Type GHC circuit
2 breakers have binding head Type GHC Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with
Non-Interchangeable Trip Units
screw-type terminals on line
2 and load side. These circuit 277 Vac Maximum,
125 Vdc Maximum 1
480Y/277 Vac Maximum,
125/250 Vdc Maximum
480Y/277 Vac Maximum,
125/250 Vdc Maximum 2
breakers with screw-type
2 terminals (0.19032) will be
marked Special purpose
Continuous
Ampere Rating
Single-Pole
Catalog
Two-Pole
Catalog
Three-Pole
Catalog
breaker not for general use. at 40 C Number Number Number
2 To order this special breaker, 25 GHC1025D GHC2025D GHC3025D
use the catalog number from
2 the tables on this page.
30 GHC1030D GHC2030D GHC3030D
35 GHC1035D GHC2035D GHC3035D
2
60 GHC1060D GHC2060D GHC3060D
70 GHC1070D GHC2070D GHC3070D
2
Type GHB and GHC Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with
2 Non-Interchangeable Trip Units for HID Lighting Applications
277 Vac Maximum
2 Continuous Single-Pole
Ampere Rating Catalog
2 Type at 40 C Number
Cable-in 15 GHC1015HID
2 20 GHC1020HID
Bolt-on 15 GHB1015HID
2 20 GHB1020HID
2 Notes
1 Single-pole breakers can be applied in DC systems from 15 through 70 amperes; 80 through 100 amperes devices are not suitable
2 for DC application.
2 Use two outside poles.
2 FDC 3 100 L
2 Circuit Breaker Suffix
Type Number of Trip Amperes E = 100% protected (four-pole only) neutral pole
2 EHD
FDB
Poles
1 = 1 pole
010
015
EH = 50% protected (four-pole only)
K = High magnetic molded case switch
FD 020 L = Line and load terminals
2
2 = 2 poles
HFD 3 = 3 poles 025 S = Stainless steel terminals
FDC 4 = 4 poles 030 V = 50 C calibration
2 035
040
W = Without terminals
Y = Line terminals only
045 Z = Aluminum terminals (100 amperes)
2 050
060
070
2 080
090
2 100
110
125
2 150
175 (FD, HFD, FDC, two-, three-, four-pole only)
200 (FD, HFD, FDC, two-, three-, four-pole only)
2 225 (FD, HFD, FDC, two-, three-, four-pole only)
2
EDC 3 200 L
2
2 Circuit Breaker
Type Number of Trip
Suffix
L = Line and load terminals
Poles Amperes
2
EDB W = Without terminals
EDS 2 = 2 poles 100 Y = Line terminals only
ED 3 = 3 poles 125 Z = Aluminum terminals (100 amperes)
2 EDH
EDC
150
175
200
2 225
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
FD-Frame Circuit Breakers with 310+ Electronic Trip Unit Technology 2
HFDE 3 225 32 ZG W 2
Performance at Features 2
480 Vac Number of W = Without terminals
FDE = 35 kAIC
HFDE = 65 kAIC
Poles
3 = 3 poles 080
Trip Units
Trip Unit Trip Unit Features
L = Line and load terminals
Blank = Load side terminals only
2
FDCE = 100 kAIC
2
160 32 = 310+ LSI ZG = Zone
225 33 = 310+ LS selective
35 = 310+ LSG interlocking
36 = 310+ LSIG Blank = No option 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
2 Type ED Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with Non-Interchangeable
Trip Units Suitable for Reverse Feed
2 240 Vac Maximum, 125 Vdc
(Includes Terminals on Load End Only)
2 65 kAIC at 240 Vac
Two-Pole Three-Pole
2 Maximum Continuous Catalog Catalog
Ampere Rating at 40 C Number Number
2 15 ED2015 ED3015
20 ED2020 ED3020
2 25 ED2025 ED3025
2 30
35
ED2030
ED2035
ED3030
ED3035
2 40 ED2040 ED3040
50 ED2050 ED3050
2 60 ED2060 ED3060
100 ED2100 ED3100
2 125 ED2125 ED3125
2 150
175
ED2150
ED2175
ED3150
ED3175
2 Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2 15
20
2 25
30
2 35
2 40
50
2 60
100 EDH2100 EDH3100
2 125 EDH2125 EDH3125
150 EDH2150 EDH3150
2 175 EDH2175 EDH3175
2
2
2
2
2
240 Vac Maximum, 125 Vdc
(Includes Terminals on Load End Only)
42 kAIC at 240 Vac
2 Two-Pole Three-Pole
Maximum Continuous Catalog Catalog
2 Ampere Rating at 40 C Number Number
100 EDS2100 EDS3100
2 110 EDS2110 EDS3110
125 EDS2125 EDS3125
2 150 EDS2150 EDS3150
2
Type EHD Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with Non-Interchangeable
2 Trip Units (Includes Terminals on Load End Only)
277 Vac Maximum, 125 Vdc 480 Vac Maximum, 250 Vdc
2 14 kAIC at 277 Vac 14 kAIC at 480 Vac
Single-Pole Two-Pole Three-Pole
2 Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
70 EHD1070 EHD2070 EHD3070
80 EHD1080 EHD2080 EHD3080
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
277 Vac Maximum, 125 Vdc 600 Vac Maximum, 250 Vdc
35 kAIC at 277 Vac 35 kAIC at 480 Vac
Single-Pole Two-Pole Three-Pole Four-Pole
2 Maximum Continuous Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
Ampere Rating at 40 C Number Number Number Number
2 10 1 FD1010
2
15 FD1015 2 FD2015 FD3015 FD4015
20 FD1020 2 FD2020 FD3020 FD4020
2 50
60
FD1050
FD1060
FD2050
FD2060
FD3050
FD3060
FD4050
FD4060
2 Notes
1 Not UL listed. 5 kAIC interrupting rating.
2
2 UL listed for SWD applications, see NEC Article 240.83(d).
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Note
2
2
1 UL listed for SWD applications, see NEC Article 240.83(d).
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
600 Vac Maximum, 250 Vdc
100 kAIC at 480 Vac
Two-Pole Three-Pole Four-Pole
2 Maximum Continuous Catalog Catalog Catalog
Ampere Rating at 40 C Number Number Number
2 15 FDC2015 FDC3015 FDC4015
2
20 FDC2020 FDC3020 FDC4020
25 FDC2025 FDC3025 FDC4025
2 60
70
FDC2060
FDC2070
FDC3060
FDC3070
FDC4060
FDC4070
210+ Trip Electronic Trip Units Amperage Settings FDE, HFDE, FDCE 225 100, 110, 125, 150, 160, 175, 200, 225 2
FDE, HFDE, FDCE 160 60, 70, 80, 90, 100, 125, 150, 160
2
Circuit
Breaker FDE, HFDE, FDCE 80 15, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80
Type Frame Ratings
FDE, HFDE, FDCE 225 100, 110, 125, 150, 175, 200, 225
Notes
1 For 210+ trip unit, 150 A not available with LSI trip unit; entire range is covered by 100 A and
2
FDE, HFDE, FDCE 150 70, 80, 90, 100, 110, 125, 150
2
225 A frames.
2 Contact the product line for availability.
FDE, HFDE, FDCE 100 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, 100
2
2
2
2 Maximum Continuous
480 Vac Maximum, 250 Vdc
Catalog
600 Vac Maximum, 250 Vdc
Catalog Catalog
Ampere Rating at 40 C Number Number Number
2 Two-Pole
2
150 FD3150K HFD3150K
225 FD3225K HFD3225K
2 Four-Pole
100 FD4100K HFD4100K
2 150 FD4150K HFD4150K
225 FD4225K HFD4225K
2 Note
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Standard Pressure Type Terminals
20 (EHD) Steel Cu/AI 1410 2.54 3T20FB 2
100 Steel Cu/AI 141/0 2.550 3T100FB
2
225 Aluminum Cu/AI 44/0 2595 3TA225FD
Optional Pressure Terminals 2
50 Aluminum Cu/AI 144 2.525 3TA50FB 2
100 Aluminum Cu/AI 141/0 2.550 3TA100FD 2
200
225
Stainless steel
Copper
Cu
Cu
44/0
44/0
2595
2595
3T150FB
3T225FD
2
225 Aluminum Cu/AI 6300 kcmil 16150 3TA225FDK3 3 2
225 Aluminum Cu/AI 6300 kcmil 16150 3TA225FDK 3 4
Notes 2
1 Use on FDE, HFDE and FDCE electronic trip only.
2 Not for use with ED, EDH, EDC breakers.
3 Includes terminal shield kit. Adds approximately 3 inches (76.2) to breaker height. Available for use on three-pole breaker only.
2
4 Replacement use only.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 Clip
2
Conductor
Washer
Conductor Conductor
2 3T20FB
Wire Clamp
3T100FB, 3T150FB
Screw
3TA225FD
Extrusion
2 Assemble wire clamp to bottom of conductor as shown. Insert collar enclosing conductor as shown. Locate nut on top of
conductor and tighten securely with screw and washer.
Insert collar enclosing conductor and center on extrusion on collar.
Install clip with legs on top of conductor and snap end around
2
2 Collar
2 Conductor
Collar
2 Washer Washer
Conductor
2 Screw
Screw
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Legend 2
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
Accessory available/modification available
2
Note 2
1 Internal accessories are listed with Underwriters Laboratories (UL) for factory installation.
They are not listed with UL for field installation.
2
2 Circuit Breaker
Type
Number
of Poles
Volts AC (50/60 Hz)
240 277 480 600
Volts DC 1
125 250 23
2 EDB
EDS
2, 3
2, 3
22
42
10
10
2 ED
EDH
2, 3
2, 3
65
100
10
10
2 EDC
EHD
2, 3
1
200
4
10
10
2 FDB
2, 3
2, 3, 4
18
18
14
14
14
10
10
2 FD 1
2, 3, 4
65
35
35
18
10
10
2
FDE 4 3 65 35 18
HFD 1 65 10
2
2, 3, 4 100 65 25 22
HFDE 4 3 100 65 25
FDC 5 2, 3, 4 200 100 35 22
2 FDCE 456 3 200 100 25
2
Interrupting Capacity (kA Symmetrical Amperes)
Circuit Breaker Number Volts AC (50/60 Hz) Volts DC 1
2
Type of Poles 220, 240 380, 415 440 500 125 250 23
EDB 2, 3 22 10
2 EDS
ED
2, 3
2, 3
42
65
10
10
2
EDH 2, 3 100 10
EDC 2, 3 200 10
2
EHD 1 14 10
2, 3 18 14 10
2
FDB 2, 3, 4 18 14 14 14 10
FD 1 35 10
2, 3, 4 65 35 35 18 10
2 HFD 1 65 10
2, 3, 4 100 65 65 25 22
2 FDC 2, 3, 4 200 100 100 35 22
2 210+ and 310+ Electronic Trip Unit Accessories UL 489 Current Limiting Data
I2T (106A2S)
2
Catalog Frame Circuit Ip (kA)
Description 210+ 310+ number
FDC 240 V/200 kA 41.4 1.41
2
Electronic portable test kit MTST230V
FDC 480 V/100 kA 38.9 2.50
Trip unit tamper protection wire seal 5108A03H01
FDC 600 V/35 kA 29.0 3.00
2 External neutral sensor (80 A) 7 CTF080
Notes
External neutral sensor (160 A) 7 CTF160 1 DC ratings apply to substantially non-inductive circuits.
2 External neutral sensor (225 A) 7 CTF225 2 Two-pole circuit breaker, or two poles of three-pole circuit breaker.
3 Time constant is 3 milliseconds minimum at 10 kA and 8 milliseconds minimum at 22 kA.
Compact external neutral sensor (80 A) 7 CTFD080
2 Compact external neutral sensor (160 A) 7 CTFD160
4 Electronics available on three-pole only, no DC rating for FDE, HFDE, FDCE.
5 Current limiting.
2
Compact external neutral sensor (225 A) 7 CTFD225 6 Check with Eaton for availability.
7 Neutral sensor required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired; sold separately.
Breaker-mount cause-of-trip indication TRIP-LED
2
S12x 1200 1800 2400
Position 6 80 160 225
Fixed instantaneous override (all 210+) 2400 2400 2400
tg = ground fault delay time (milliseconds) Position 1 Inst Inst Inst
2
Isd (x Ir) / tsd = SD profile 2 Isd / tsd 100 150 225
(210+ LSI version) (LSG, LSIG)
J 2x / 150 N/A 2x / 150 Position 2 120 120 120
K
L
2x / 300
2x / I2t
N/A
N/A
2x / 300
2x / I2t Independently Adjustable Instantaneous (Ii) setting
Position 3
1
300 300 300
2
M
N
4x / Inst
4x / 150
N/A
N/A
4x / Inst
4x / 150
Maintenance Mode pickup (2.5 x In) (amperes) 2
2
Notes
O 4x / I2t N/A 4x / I2t 1 Not available for FD. Independently adjustable I setting available in LG, NG and
i 2
P 6x / Inst N/A 6x / Inst RG ALSI and ALSIG trip units.
Q 6x / 300 N/A 6x / 300
2 Maintenance Mode not available for FD frames. It is available for KD, LD, MDL, LG, NG
and RG. 2
R 10x / 150 N/A 10x / 150
S 10x / 300 N/A 10x / 300 2
2
2 FD Frame
2
FD Frame, Three-Pole
2 Front View Side View
2
2
2
On
2 Off
2 6.00
(152.4)
2
2
2
2 4.13 3.38
(104.9) (85.7)
2
2 Approximate Shipping Weight Lbs (kg)
2 FD Frame
2
Number of Poles
Breaker Type 1 2 3 4
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 JD 3 250 F
2 Circuit Breaker/ Suffix
Frame Type Number of Circuit Breaker/Frame C = Non-aluminum terminals
2 JDB
JD
Poles Ampere Rating F = Frame only
K = High magnetic molded case switch
2 = 2 poles 070
2
HJD 3 = 3 poles 090 V = 50 C calibration
JDC 4 = 4 poles 100 W = Without terminals
125 X = Load side terminals only
2 150
175
Y = Line side terminals only
200
2 225
250
2
Trip Unit
2
JT 3 250 T
2
2 Trip Unit Type
JT = Thermal-magnetic Number Trip Unit Rating/ T = Trip unit
Suffix
2
of Poles Plug Ampere Rating thermal-magnetic
2 = 2 poles 070 fixed thermal
3 = 3 poles 090 adj. magnetic
2 4 = 4 poles 100
125
V = 50 C calibration
(thermal-magnetic
150 trip units only)
2 175
200
2 225
250
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Types JD, HJD and JDC Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers Molded Case Switches
2 Frame Only Eatons molded case components and are of the
switches are used as high instantaneous automatic
2
Standard Interrupting High Interrupting Ultra High Interrupting
Capacity Capacity Capacity Current Limiting compact switches in type. Molded case switches
600 Vac Rated 600 Vac Rated 600 Vac Rated applications requiring high are listed in accordance with
2 35 kAIC at 480 Vac
Catalog
65 kAIC at 480 Vac
Catalog
100 kAIC at 480 Vac
Catalog
current switching capabilities. Underwriters Laboratories
Molded case switches are Standard UL 489.
Number Number Number
2 Two-Pole
constructed of circuit breaker
Continuous Load Terminals Load Terminals Only 250 JD3250KW JDB3250KW TA250KB 1
2 Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
HJD3250KW HJDB3250KW
Four-Pole
2 Two-Pole
250 JD4250KW JDB4250KW TA250KB 1
70 JDB2070W JDB2070
2
HJD4250KW HJDB4250KW
90 JDB2090W JDB2090
Notes
100 JDB2100W JDB2100
2 125 JDB2125W JDB2125
1 Individually packed.
2
Three-Pole
70 JDB3070W JDB3070
2 90 JDB3090W JDB3090
100 JDB3100W JDB3100
2 125 JDB3125W JDB3125
150 JDB3150W JDB3150
2 175 JDB3175W JDB3175
2 200
225
JDB3200W
JDB3225W
JDB3200
JDB3225
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Accessories
2
Allowable Accessory Combinations
2 Different combinations of accessories can be supplied, depending on the types of accessories
and the number of poles in the circuit breaker.
2
2 JD Frame Accessories
Two-, Three-Pole Four-Pole
2
Reference
Description Page Left Center Right Left Center Right Neutral
2
Internal Accessories (Only One Internal Accessory Per Pole)
Alarm lockout (Make/Break) V4-T2-275
2 JD Frame
Number of Poles Width Height Depth
2 2, 3 4.13 (105.0) 10.00 (254.0) 4.06 (104.1)
2 JD-Frame, Three-Pole
2 Front View
Side View
2
Front View Cutout 4.13
(104.8)
2 0.34 R
1.56
(39.7)
0.78
(19.8)
2
(8.7 R)
CL Handle
2.92
2 3.94
(100.0)
(74.2)
10.00 ON
2 CL Breaker
0.88
(22.2) (254.0)
3.33
2
0.19 R
(4.8) R (84.5)
0.72 OFF
(18.2)
2 0.50 (12.7)
Diameter 2.75
1.38
(34.9)
3 Megger Holes (69.9)
2 if Required 3.50
(88.9)
1.75
(44.5)
2 4.06
(103.2)
2
2 Approximate Shipping Weight in Lbs (kg)
2 JD Frame
Breaker Complete Breaker Frame Only Trip Unit
2 Type Two-Pole Three-Pole Four-Pole Two-Pole Three-Pole Four-Pole Two-Pole Three-Pole Four-Pole
JDB 11.25 (5.1) 12.50 (5.7)
2 JD 11.25 (5.1) 12.50 (5.7) 13.25 (6.0) 9.00 (4.1) 10.00 (4.5) 10.50 (4.8) 2.00 (0.9) 2.00 (0.9) 2.25 (1.0)
2
HJD 11.25 (5.1) 12.50 (5.7) 13.25 (6.0) 9.00 (4.1) 10.00 (4.5) 10.50 (4.8) 2.00 (0.9) 2.00 (0.9) 2.25 (1.0)
JDC 12.25 (5.6) 13.50 (6.1) 14.25 (6.5) 10.00 (4.5) 11.00 (5.0) 11.50 (5.2) 2.00 (0.9) 2.00 (0.9) 2.25 (1.0)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 KT 3 400 F
2 Trip Unit Type Suffix
2 225
250
300
2 350
400
2 Notes
1 Frames are the same for thermal-magnetic or 310+ electronic trip units, e.g., KD3400F or HKD3400F.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
2 Types KD, HKD and KDC Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Trip Units
2 Standard Interrupting
Capacity
High Interrupting
Capacity
Ultra High Interrupting
Capacity Current Limiting
600 Vac Rated 600 Vac Rated 600 Vac Rated Thermal-Magnetic
2 35 kAIC at 480 Vac
Factory Assembled
65 kAIC at 480 Vac
Factory Assembled
100 kAIC at 480 Vac
Factory Assembled
Trip Unit Only 1
Standard Terminals Only
2 Maximum
Circuit Consisting
of Frame, Trip Unit
Circuit Consisting
of Frame, Trip Unit
Circuit Consisting
of Frame, Trip Unit
For Use with Standard
or High or Ultra High See Page V4-T2-179 for
Continuous and Terminals 1 and Terminals 1 and Terminals 1 Interrupting Frames Optional Terminals
2 Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2 Two-Pole
100 KD2100 HKD2100 KDC2100 KT2100T TA300K 2
2 125 KD2125 HKD2125 KDC2125 KT2125T TA300K 2
2
150 KD2150 HKD2150 KDC2150 KT2150T TA300K 2
175 KD2175 HKD2175 KDC2175 KT2175T TA300K 2
2 400
Three-Pole
KD2400 HKD2400 KDC2400 KT2400T 2TA400K 3
2 225
250
KD3225
KD3250
HKD3225
HKD3250
KDC3225
KDC3250
KT3225T
KT3250T
TA300K 2
TA350K 2
2
Four-Pole
100 KD4100 HKD4100 KDC4100 KT3100T TA300K 2
2 300
350
KD4300
KD4350
HKD4300
HKD4350
KDC4300
KDC4350
KT3300T
KT3350T
TA350K 2
TA350K 2
Notes
2 1 Magnetic trip adjustable 510 times continuous ampere rating.
2 Individually packed.
2 3 2TA400K, 3TA400K and 4TA400K terminal kits contain one terminal for each pole and one terminal cover.
2
2
2
Standard Options
Ultra High
2
Interrupting LS LSI LSG LSIG
Standard High Capacity Adjustable Independently
Interrupting Interrupting Current Short Time Adjustable
Capacity
600 Vac
Capacity
600 Vac
Limiting
600 Vac
Adjustable
Short Time
Independently
Adjustable
Pickup with
I2t Short
Short Time
Pickup and
2
Max.
Rated Rated Rated Pickup with Short Time Delay and Delay and
Cont.
Ampere 35 kAIC at 65 kAIC at 100 kAIC I2t Short Pickup and Ground Fault Ground Fault Neutral CT for 2
Rating 480 Vac 480 Vac at 480 Vac Delay Ramp Delay Protection Protection LSG and LSIG 23 Terminal
at 40 C Catalog Number Catalog Number Information
2
125 KD4400F HKD4400F KDC4400F KES4125LS KES4125LSI See Page
250 KD4400F HKD4400F KDC4400F KES4250LS KES4250LSI
V4-T2-179
2
400 KD4400F HKD4400F KDC4400F KES4400LS KES4400LSI
Notes
2
2
1 For AC use only.
2 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired.
3 Included with LSG and LSIG trip units.
4 Trip unit includes protected neutral pole. Use corresponding three-pole trip unit if protected neutral pole is not required. 2
5 Fully rated neutral pole protection is standard. For 50% rated protection on neutral pole, add Suffix E to four-pole trip unit catalog number.
2
2
2
2
Type KDB with Digitrip 310+ Non-Interchangeable Trip Unit Suitable for Reverse Feed
2 See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-182.
2 Factory Assembled Circuit Breaker Consisting of Frame and Trip Unit Less Terminals 1
Standard Optional
2 LS LSI LSG
Adjustable Short Time
LSIG
Maximum
Adjustable Short Time Independently Adjustable Pickup with I2t Short Independently Adjustable
2 Continuous
Ampere Pickup with I2t Short Short Time Pickup and Delay and Ground Fault Short Time Pickup and Neutral CT for
Rating Number Delay Ramp Delay Protection Ground Fault Protection LSG and LSIG 23 Terminal
2 at 40 C of Poles Catalog Number Catalog Number Information
125 3 KDB3125FT33W KDB3125FT32W KDB3125FT35W KDB3125FT36W LGFCT125 See Page
2 250 3 KDB3250FT33W KDB3250FT32W KDB3250FT35W KDB3250FT36W LGFCT250
V4-T2-180
2
400 3 KDB3400FT33W KDB3400FT32W KDB3400FT35W KDB3400FT36W LGFCT400
2 Type HKDB with Digitrip 310+ Non-Interchangeable Trip Unit Suitable for Reverse Feed
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-182.
2
Factory Assembled Circuit Breaker Consisting of Frame and Trip Unit Less Terminals 1
2 Standard
LS
Optional
LSI LSG LSIG
2 Maximum
Continuous Adjustable Short Time
Adjustable Short Time
Independently Adjustable Pickup with I2t Short Independently Adjustable
Pickup with I2t Short Short Time Pickup and Delay and Ground Fault Short Time Pickup and Neutral CT for
2
Ampere
Rating Number Delay Ramp Delay Protection Ground Fault Protection LSG and LSIG 23 Terminal
at 40 C of Poles Catalog Number Catalog Number Information
2 125 3 HKDB3125FT33W HKDB3125FT32W HKDB3125FT35W HKDB3125FT36W LGFCT125 See Page
V4-T2-180
250 3 HKDB3250FT33W HKDB3250FT32W HKDB3250FT35W HKDB3250FT36W LGFCT250
2 400 3 HKDB3400FT33W HKDB3400FT32W HKDB3400FT35W HKDB3400FT36W LGFCT400
2
2
100% Rated Types CKD and CHKD Electronic Circuit Breakers
The NEC allows the breaker to be rated at 100% of its frame size in an assembly, provided that 90 C wire is applied at the 75 C
ampacity. All 100% rated circuit breakers have electronic trip units.
2
100% Rated Types CKD and CHKD Electronic Circuit BreakersThree-Pole
2 See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-182.
2 Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip RMS 310+ Trip Unit Only
Standard Options
2 Standard High
Adjustable
Short Time
Independently
Adjustable
2
Interrupting Interrupting Adjustable Independently Pickup with Short Time
Maximum Capacity Capacity Short Time Adjustable I2t Short Pickup and
Continuous Pickup with Short Time Delay and Delay and
2 Ampere
Rating
35 kAIC at
480 Vac
65 kAIC at
480 Vac
I2t Short
Delay Ramp
Pickup and
Delay
Ground Fault
Protection
Ground Fault
Protection
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 23 Terminal
at 40 C Catalog Number Catalog Number Information
2 125 CKD3400F CHKD3400F KES3125LS KES3125LSI KES3125LSG KES3125LSIG LGFCT125 See Page
V4-T2-179
2 250 CKD3400F CHKD3400F KES3250LS KES3250LSI KES3250LSG KES3250LSIG LGFCT250
400 CKD3400F CHKD3400F KES3400LS KES3400LSI KES3400LSG KES3400LSIG LGFCT400
2 Notes
1 For AC use only.
2
2
2
2
2
Molded Case Switches
2 240 Vac Maximum, 250 Vdc 600 Vac Maximum, 250 Vdc 600 Vac Maximum, 250 Vdc
Complete Circuit Breaker
2 Maximum
Continuous
Complete Circuit Breaker
with Standard Line and
Complete Circuit Breaker
with Standard Line and
with Standard Line and
Load Terminals. Suitable for
Load Terminals Load Terminals Reverse Feed Use
2
Ampere
Rating Catalog Catalog Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Number
2 Two-Pole
400 DK2400K KD2400K KDB2400K
2 HKD2400K HKDB2400K
2 Three-Pole
400 DK3400K KD3400K KDB3400K
2 HKD3400K HKDB3400K
Four-Pole
2 400 KD4400K KDB4400K
2
HKD4400K HKDB4400K
Note
2 Molded case switches may open above 4000 amperes.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
2
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number. 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Digitrip OPTIM 550 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
2 Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip OPTIM Rating Plug Only
2 L Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
S Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
2 G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
2
OPTIM 550 2
Continuous
Ampere LSI LSIG LSIA Fixed Rating Plug
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Number Rating Number
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
125 HKD3125T52W HKD3125T56W HKD3125T57W 70 ORPK125A70
2 90 ORPK125A90
100 ORPK125A100
2 110 ORPK125A110
125 ORPK125A125
2 250 HKD3250T52W HKD3250T56W HKD3250T57W 125 ORPK025A125
2 150
175
ORPK025A150
ORPK025A175
2 200 ORPK025A200
225 ORPK025A225
2 250 ORPK025A250
400 HKD3400T52W HKD3400T56W HKD3400T57W 200 ORPK40A200
2 225 ORPK40A225
2 250
300
ORPK40A250
ORPK40A300
2 350 ORPK40A350
400 ORPK40A400
2 Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Number Rating Number
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity Current Limiting 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
125 KDC3125T52W KDC3125T56W KDC3125T57W 70 ORPK125A70
2
90 ORPK125A90
2
100 ORPK125A100
110 ORPK125A110 2
125 ORPK125A125
250 KDC3250T52W KDC3250T56W KDC3250T57W 125 ORPK025A125 2
2
150 ORPK025A150
175 ORPK025A175
200 ORPK025A200
2
225 ORPK025A225
250 ORPK025A250 2
400 KDC3400T52W KDC3400T56W KDC3400T57W 200 ORPK40A200
225 ORPK40A225 2
250
300
ORPK40A250
ORPK40A300
2
350 ORPK40A350 2
400 ORPK40A400
Notes
2
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number. 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug
2 Order as individual components: breaker frame (which includes trip unit), rating plug, terminals.
2
Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug
2 Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip OPTIM Rating Plug Only
2 L
S
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
2 G
A
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
2
OPTIM 1050 2
Continuous
Ampere LSIG LSIA Fixed Rating Plug
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Rating Number
2
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 35 kAIC at 480 Vac
125 KD3125T106W KD3125T107W 70 ORPK125A70
2 90 ORPK125A90
100 ORPK125A100
2 110 ORPK125A110
125 ORPK125A125
2 250 KD3250T106W KD3250T107W 125 ORPK025A125
2
150 ORPK025A150
175 ORPK025A175
2 200 ORPK025A200
225 ORPK025A225
2 250 ORPK025A250
400 KD3400T106W KD3400T107W 200 ORPK40A200
2 225 ORPK40A22
2 250
300
ORPK40A250
ORPK40A300
2 350 ORPK40A350
400 ORPK40A400
2 Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 2 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Rating Number
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
125 HKD3125T106W HKD3125T107W 70 ORPK125A70
2
90 ORPK125A90
2
100 ORPK125A100
110 ORPK125A110 2
125 ORPK125A125
250 HKD3250T106W HKD3250T107W 125 ORPK025A125 2
2
150 ORPK025A150
175 ORPK025A175
200 ORPK025A200
2
225 ORPK025A225
250 ORPK025A250 2
400 HKD3400T106W HKD3400T107W 200 ORPK40A200
225 ORPK40A225 2
250
300
ORPK40A250
ORPK40A300
2
350 ORPK40A350 2
400 ORPK40A400
Notes
2
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Factory sealed. 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
2 Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip OPTIM Rating Plug Only
2 L
S
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
2 G
A
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
2
OPTIM 1050 2
Continuous
Ampere LSIG LSIA Fixed Rating Plug
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Rating Number
2
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity Current Limiting 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
125 KDC3125T106W KDC3125T107W 70 ORPK125A70
2 90 ORPK125A90
100 ORPK125A100
2 110 ORPK125A110
125 ORPK125A125
2 250 KDC3250T106W KDC3250T107W 125 ORPK025A125
2 150
175
ORPK025A150
ORPK025A175
2 200 ORPK025A200
225 ORPK025A225
2 250 ORPK025A250
400 KDC3400T106W KDC3400T107W 200 ORPK40A200
2 225 ORPK40A225
2 250
300
ORPK40A250
ORPK40A300
2 350 ORPK40A350
400 ORPK40A400
2 Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 2 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
2
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number 2
(refer to Page V4-T2-293).
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 550 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
2 Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip OPTIM Rating Plug Only
2 L
S
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
2 G
A
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
2
OPTIM 550 2
Continuous
Ampere LSI LSIG LSIA Fixed Rating Plug
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Number Rating Number
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
125 CHKD3125T52W CHKD3125T56W CHKD3125T57W 70 ORPK125A70
2 90 ORPK125A90
100 ORPK125A100
2 110 ORPK125A110
125 ORPK125A125
2 250 CHKD3250T52W CHKD3250T56W CHKD3250T57W 125 ORPK025A125
2 150
175
ORPK025A150
ORPK025A175
2 200 ORPK025A200
225 ORPK025A225
2 250 ORPK025A250
400 CHKD3400T52W CHKD3400T56W CHKD3400T57W 200 ORPK40A200
2 225 ORPK40A225
2 250
300
ORPK40A250
ORPK40A300
2 350 ORPK40A350
400 ORPK40A400
2 Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
2
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Factory sealed. 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
2 Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip OPTIM Rating Plug Only
2 L
S
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
2 G
A
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
2
OPTIM 1050 2
Continuous
Ampere LSIG LSIA Fixed Rating Plug
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Rating Number
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
125 CHKD3125T106W CHKD3125T107W 70 ORPK125A70
2 90 ORPK125A90
100 ORPK125A100
2 110 ORPK125A110
125 ORPK125A125
2 250 CHKD3250T106W CHKD3250T107W 125 ORPK025A125
2 150
175
ORPK025A150
ORPK025A175
2 200 ORPK025A200
225 ORPK025A225
2 250 ORPK025A250
400 CHKD3400T106W CHKD3400T107W 200 ORPK40A200
2 225 ORPK40A225
2 250
300
ORPK40A250
ORPK40A300
2 350 ORPK40A350
400 ORPK40A400
2 Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 2 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
3T400K 4 3T400KCW 24
4T400K 5 4T400KCW 56
2
400 Aluminum Cu/AI 2/0250 (2) 70120 2TA401K 23 2TA401KCW 23
or
2/0500 (1)
70240 3TA401K 24 3TA401KCW 24 2
70240 4TA401K 56 4TA401KCW 56
400 Aluminum Cu/AI 500750 (1) 300400 2TA402K 23 2
2
3TA402K 24
4TA402K 56
400 Copper Cu 500750 (1) 2T402K 23 2
3T402K 24
4T402K 56 2
Notes
1 Individually packed. 2
2 Terminal kits contain one terminal for each pole and one terminal cover.
3 Two-pole kit. 2
4 Three-pole kit.
5 Four-pole kit.
6 Terminal kits contain one terminal for each pole and three interphase barriers.
2
2
Accessories
2 Allowable Accessory Combinations
2 Different combinations of accessories can be supplied, depending on the types of accessories
and the number of poles in the circuit breaker.
2 KD Frame Accessories
Two-Pole 1 Three-Pole Four-Pole
2 Description
Reference
Page Left Right Left Center Right Left Center Right Neutral
Internal Accessories (Only One Internal Accessory Per Pole)
2 Alarm lockout (Make/Break) V4-T2-276
Alarm lockout (2Make/2Break) V4-T2-276
2 Auxiliary switch (1A, 1B) V4-T2-278
Auxiliary switch (2A, 2B) V4-T2-278
2 Auxiliary switch (3A, 3B) V4-T2-278
Auxiliary switch and alarm switch combination V4-T2-279
2 Shunt tripstandard 2 V4-T2-282
Shunt triplow energy 2 V4-T2-285
2 Undervoltage release mechanism 2
PowerNet or zone interlock kit (OPTIM 550)
V4-T2-290
V4-T2-293
2 External Accessories
End cap kit V4-T2-310
2 Keeper nut
Control wire terminal kit
V4-T2-310
V4-T2-311
2 Terminal adapter
Multiwire connectors
V4-T2-311
V4-T2-312
2
Rear fed terminals V4-T2-312
Base mounting hardware V4-T2-313
Terminal shields V4-T2-315
2 Interphase barriers V4-T2-315
Non-padlockable handle block V4-T2-316
2 Padlockable handle block V4-T2-316
Padlockable handle lock hasp V4-T2-317
2 Cylinder lock V4-T2-317
Key Interlock kit V4-T2-318
2 Sliding bar interlockrequires two breakers V4-T2-319
Walking beam interlockrequires two breakers V4-T2-319
2 Electrical (solenoid) operator V4-T2-320
Plug-in adapters V4-T2-321
2 Rear connecting studs
Panelboard connecting straps
V4-T2-323
V4-T2-324
2 Handle mechanisms
Handle extension
V4-T2-431
V4-T2-446
2 IQ Energy Sentinel
Solid-state (electronic) portable test kit
V4-T2-326
V4-T2-326
2
Digitrip OPTIMizer V4-T2-327
Auxiliary power module V4-T2-327
Modifications (Refer to Eaton)
2 Special calibration
Moisture fungus treatment V4-T2-116
2 Freeze-tested circuit breakers
Marine/naval application
2 Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
2 May be mounted on left or right polenot both
Accessory available/modification available
2 Notes
1 Two-pole breaker supplied in three-pole frame. Current carrying parts omitted from center pole.
2 2 Shunt trip and UVR cannot be mounted in right poles on KES or OPTIM trip units. Standard internal accessories cannot be mounted in right pole on any K-Frame OPTIM trip unites. Special OPTIM
ground fault and zone interlock accessories are available for field installation in the right pole of K-Frame 550 OPTIM trip units. Factory installed 2a/2b and bell/aux are available for factory
2
installation. K-Frame breakers equipped with OPTIM 1050 trip units include aux-bell alarm in the right pole.
2
2
2
2
2
2
Interchangeable trip unit Yes tr = long delay time (seconds) 2 2 2 2
High load alarm, trip (suffix B20) 1 Yes (All 310+)
4 4 4 4
2 Ground fault alarm with trip (suffix B21) 1 LSG, LSIG, ALSIG 7 7 7 7
Ground fault alarm, no trip (suffix B22) LSG, LSIG, ALSIG 10 10 10 10
2 Zone selective interlock (suffix ZG) 1 LSI, LSIG, ALSI, ALSIG 12 12 12 12
Cause of trip indication Yes (via TRIP-LED or DIGIVIEW) 15 15 15 15
2 Thru-cover accessories No 20 20 20 20
2
(All 310+)
Position 2 3 3x 3x
Position 3 4 4x 4x
2 Position 4 5 5x 5x
Position 5 6 6x 6x
2 Position 6 7 7x 7x
2 Position 7 8 8x 8x
Position 8 10 10x 10x
2
tg = ground fault delay time (milliseconds) Position 1 Inst
(LSG, LSIG, ALSIG)
Position 2 120
2 Position 3
2
300
Independently adjustable Instantaneous (Ii) setting
2 Maintenance Mode pickup (2.5 x In) (amperes) Fixed 312 625 1000
(310+ with Maintenance ModeALSI and ALSIG)
2 Notes
1 B2x suffixes cannot be combined with B2x suffixes.
2 2 Not available for KD. Independently adjustable I setting available in LG, NG and RG ALSI and
2
2
2
Instantaneous pickup 200800% x (In) 200800% x (In)
Discriminator Yes Yes
2
Instantaneous override Yes Yes
Ground Fault Protection (G)
2
Ground fault alarm 20100% x (Is) 20100% x (Is)
Ground fault pickup 20100% x (Is) 20100% x (Is)
Ground fault delay I2t
2
100500 ms 100500 ms
Ground fault delay flat 100500 ms 100500 ms
2
Ground fault zone selective interlocking Yes 1 Yes
Ground fault thermal memory Yes Yes
2
System Diagnostics
Status LEDs Yes Yes
2
Cause of trip LEDs Yes Yes
Magnitude of trip information Yes Yes
Remote signal contactground alarm Yes 1 Yes
Local auxiliary and bell alarm contact Optional Included 2
System Monitoring
Digital display Yes 2 Yes 2 2
Current Yes Yes
Power and energy No Yes 2
Power qualityharmonics No Yes
Power factor No Yes 2
Communications
PowerNet Yes 3 Yes 2
Testing
Testing method OPTIMizer, BIM, PowerNet OPTIMizer, BIM, PowerNet 2
Legend
BIM = Breaker Interface Module
2
(A) = GF Alarm
Is = Sensor Rating
In = Rating Plug 2
Ir = Long Delay Pickup Setting
Notes 2
1 Zone interlock kit.
2 By OPTIMizer/BIM.
3 Eatons PowerNet kit.
2
2
2 KD Frame
Number
2 of Poles Width Height Depth
2, 3 5.50 (149.7) 10.13 (257.3) 4.10 (104.1)
2 4 7.22 (183.4) 10.13 (257.3) 4.10 (104.1)
0.83
2 0.19 R
(4.8 R)
(21.0) 1.64
(41.7)
ON
1.25
2
10.13
(31.8) (257.2)
1.31
OFF
2
(33.3)
2.63
(66.7)
2.39
2 4.78
(121.5)
(60.7)
2
2
2 Approximate Shipping Weight, Lbs (kg)
2 KD Frame
Complete Breaker Frame Only Trip Unit 1
2 Breaker
Type Two-Pole Three-Pole Two-Pole Three-Pole Two-Pole Three-Pole
2
HKD, HKDB 10.0 (4.5) 11.5 (5.2) 7.5 (3.4) 8.5 (3.9) 1.5 (0.7) 1.5 (0.7)
KDC 10.0 (4.5) 11.5 (5.2) 7.5 (3.4) 8.5 (3.9) 1.5 (0.7) 1.5 (0.7)
2 Note
1 Weights shown are for thermal-magnetic trip units. Three-pole electronic trip units weigh 2.5 lbs (1.1 kg).
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 LD 3 600 F
2
Circuit Breaker/ Suffix
2 LDB
Frame Type Number
of Poles
Circuit Breaker/
Frame Ampere
C = Copper terminals
F = Frame only (600 A only)
LD Rating K = High magnetic molded case switch
2
2 = Two-pole
HLD 3 = Three-pole 300 V = 50 C (thermal-magnetic trip units only)
LDC 4 = Four-pole 350 W = Without terminals
2 CLD
CHLD
400
450
X = Load side terminals only
Y = Line side terminals only
CLDC 500
2 600
2 LT 3 400 T
2 Trip Unit Type Suffix
LT = Thermal-magnetic Number Trip Unit Rating/Plug T = Trip unit thermal-magnetic fixed thermal
2 of Poles Ampere Rating adjustable magnetic
V = 50 C calibration (thermal-magnetic trip units only)
2 = Two-pole 300
2 3 = Three-pole
4 = Four-pole
350
400
450
2 500
600
2 Note
1 Frames are the same for thermal-magnetic or 310+ electronic trip units, e.g., LD3600F, HLD3600F, etc.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
F
Designation T39 = 310+ Electronic LSIG with Maintenance Mode 1
2
310+ Electronic Trip Units 2 2
LES 3 600 LSIG B22ZG 2
2
2
Trip Unit Type Features
LES Number Trip Unit Blank = No feature
of Poles LS = 310+ Electronic LS B20 = High load alarm
3 = Three-pole
4 = Four-pole
Amperes LSI = 310+ Electronic LSI B21 =
B22 =
Ground fault alarm, with trip 1
Ground fault alarm, no trip 1
2
600 LSG = 310+ Electronic LSG 1
2
LSIG = 310+ Electronic LSIG 1 ZG = Zone selective interlocking
ALSI = 310+ Electronic LSI with Maintenance Mode
ALSIG = 310+ Electronic LSIG with Maintenance Mode 1
2
LD-Frame with OPTIM Electronic Trip Unit Technology 2
OPTIM Circuit Breakers
2
LD 3 125 T5 7 W
2
Circuit Breaker/
Frame Type Number Trip Type
Suffix
W = Without terminals
2
of Poles
2
LD Circuit Breaker/ 2 = LSI (550 only)
HLD 3 = Three-pole Frame Ampere Rating 6 = LSIG
LDC 125 (Available on Model 1050 only) 7 = LSIA
CLD
CHLD
250 (Available on Model 1050 only)
400 Trip Model
2
CLDC 600
T5 = Model 550
T10 = Model 1050 2
Notes
1 Not available in four-pole configurations.
2
2 Frames are the same for thermal-magnetic or 310+ electronic trip units, e.g., LD3600F, HLD3600F, etc.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
Types LD, HLD and LDC Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Trip Units
2 Standard Interrupting High Interrupting Ultra High Interrupting
Capacity Capacity Capacity Current Limiting
2 600 Vac Rated
35 kAIC at 480 Vac
600 Vac Rated
65 kAIC at 480 Vac
600 Vac Rated
100 kAIC at 480 Vac
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit Only
2 Maximum
Factory Assembled
Circuit Consisting of Factory Assembled Factory Assembled Circuit For Use with Standard
Standard Terminals Only
Continuous Frame, Trip Unit and Circuit Consisting of Frame, Consisting of Frame, or High or Ultra High See Page V4-T2-203 for
2 Ampere
Rating
Terminals
Catalog
Trip Unit and Terminals
Catalog
Trip Unit and Terminals
Catalog
Interrupting Frames
Catalog
Optional Terminals
Catalog
2
at 40 C 1 Number Number Number Number Number
Two-Pole
2
450 LD3450 HLD3450 LDC3450 LT3450T TA602LD 2
500 LD3500 HLD3500 LDC3500 LT3500T TA602LD 2
2 450
500
LD4450
LD4500
HLD4450
HLD4500
LDC4450
LDC4500
LT4450T
LT4500T
TA602LD 2
TA602LD 2
2
Types LD, HLD and LDC Thermal-Magnetic Circuit BreakersFrame Only
2 Ultra High Interrupting
Standard Interrupting High Interrupting Capacity Capacity Current Limiting
2 Three-Pole
LD3600F HLD3600F LDC3600F
2 Four-Pole
LD4600F HLD4600F LDC4600F
2 Notes
1 Magnetic trip range 510 times continuous ampere rating.
2 2 Individually packed.
3 Terminal kits contain one terminal for each pole and one terminal cover.
2
2
100% Rated Types CLD, CHLD and CLDC Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Trip Units
2
The NEC allows the breaker to be rated at 100% of its frame size in an assembly, provided that 90 C wire is applied at the 75 C
ampacity. All 100% rated circuit breakers have electronic trip units. Order as individual components: breaker frame, trip unit and
2
terminals. See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-182.
2
100% Rated Types CLD, CHLD and CLDC Electronic Circuit Breakers with 310+ Interchangeable Trip Units
Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip RMS 310+ Trip Unit Only 2
Standard Optional
Ultra High LS LSI LSG LSIG 2
Standard Interrupting Adjustable Short Independently
Maximum
Continuous
Interrupting
Capacity 600 Vac
High Interrupting Capacity Current
Capacity 600 Vac Limiting 600 Vac
Adjustable Short Independently Time Pickup with
Time Pickup with Adjustable Short I2t Short Delay
Adjustable Short
Time Pickup and
2
Rated 35 kAIC at Rated 65 kAIC at Rated 100 kAIC 2
I t Short Delay Time Pickup and and Ground Fault Ground Fault Neutral CT for
2
Ampere
Rating 480 Vac 480 Vac at 480 Vac Ramp Delay Protection Protection LSG and LSIG 23 Terminal
at 40 C Catalog Number Catalog Number Information
Three-Pole 2
600 CLD3600F CHLD3600F CLDC3600F LES3600LS LES3600LSI LES3600LSG LES3600LSIG LGFCT600 See Page
V4-T2-180 2
Notes
1 For AC use only. 2
2 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired.
3 Included with LSG and LSIG trip units.
4 Neutral is in right pole.
2
2
2
2
350 LDB3350W LDB3350 600 LDB2600WK 1 2TA603LDK
400 LDB3400W LDB3400 600 HLD2600WK 2TA603LDK
2
Notes
1 Factory sealedsuitable for reverse feed application.
Digitrip OPTIM 550 Electronic Circuit Breaker with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
2 Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip OPTIM Rating Plug Only
2 L Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
S Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
2 G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
2
OPTIM 550 2
Continuous
Ampere LSI LSIG LSIA Fixed Rating Plug
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Number Rating Number
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
125 HLD3125T52W HLD3125T56W HLD3125T57W 70 ORPL125A070
2 90 ORPL125A090
100 ORPL125A100
2 110 ORPL125A110
125 ORPL125A125
2 250 HLD3250T52W HLD3250T56W HLD3250T57W 125 ORPL025A125
2 150
175
ORPL025A150
ORPL025A175
2 200 ORPL025A200
225 ORPL025A225
2 250 ORPL025A250
400 HLD3400T52W HLD3400T56W HLD3400T57W 200 ORPL40A200
2 225 ORPL40A225
2 250
300
ORPL40A250
ORPL40A300
2 350 ORPL40A350
400 ORPL40A400
2 600 HLD3600T52W HLD3600T56W HLD3600T57W 300 ORPL60A300
2
350 ORPL60A350
400 ORPL60A400
2 500 ORPL60A500
600 ORPL60A600
2 Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Number Rating Number
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity Current Limiting 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
125 LDC3125T52W LDC3125T56W LDC3125T57W ORPL125A070
2
ORPL125A090
2
ORPL125A100
ORPL125A110 2
ORPL125A125
250 LDC3250T52W LDC3250T56W LDC3250T57W ORPL025A125 2
2
ORPL025A150
ORPL025A175
ORPL025A200
2
ORPL025A225
ORPL025A250 2
400 LDC3400T52W LDC3400T56W LDC3400T57W 200 ORPL40A200
225 ORPL40A225 2
250
300
ORPL40A250
ORPL40A300
2
350 ORPL40A350 2
400 ORPL40A400
600 LDC3600T52W LDC3600T56W LDC3600T57W 300 ORPL60A300 2
350 ORPL60A350
400 ORPL60A400
2
500 ORPL60A500
2
600 ORPL60A600
Notes 2
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breaker with Interchangeable Rating Plug
Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip OPTIM Rating Plug Only
2 L Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
S Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
2 I
G
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
2 Maximum
Continuous
OPTIM 1050 23
LSIG LSIA Fixed Rating Plug
2
Ampere
Rating Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Rating Number
2 Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 35 kAIC at 480 Vac
125 LD3125T106W LD3125T107W 70 ORPL125A070
2 90 ORPL125A090
2 100 ORPL125A100
110 ORPL125A110
2 125 ORPL125A125
250 LD3250T106W LD3250T107W 125 ORPL025A125
2 150 ORPL025A150
2
175 ORPL025A175
200 ORPL025A200
2 225 ORPL025A225
250 ORPL025A250
2 400 LD3400T106W LD3400T107W 200 ORPL40A200
225 ORPL40A225
2 250 ORPL40A250
2 300
350
ORPL40A300
ORPL40A350
2 400 ORPL40A400
600 LD3600T106W LD3600T107W 300 ORPL60A300
2 350 ORPL60A350
400 ORPL60A400
2 500 ORPL60A500
2 600 ORPL60A600
Notes
2 1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 One Form C auxiliary switch and one Form C bell alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
2
3 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Rating Number
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
125 HLD3125T106W HLD3125T107W 70 ORPL125A070
2
90 ORPL125A090
2
100 ORPL125A100
110 ORPL125A110 2
125 ORPL125A125
250 HLD3250T106W HLD3250T107W 125 ORPL025A125 2
2
150 ORPL025A150
175 ORPL025A175
200 ORPL025A200
2
225 ORPL025A225
250 ORPL025A250 2
400 HLD3400T106W HLD3400T107W 200 ORPL40A200
225 ORPL40A225 2
250
300
ORPL40A250
ORPL40A300
2
350 ORPL40A350 2
400 ORPL40A400
600 HLD3600T106W HLD3600T107W 300 ORPL60A300 2
350 ORPL60A350
400 ORPL60A400
2
500 ORPL60A500
2
600 ORPL60A600
Notes 2
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 One Form C auxiliary switch and one Form C bell alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
3 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breaker with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
2 Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip OPTIM Rating Plug Only
2 L
S
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
2 G
A
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
2
OPTIM 1050 23
Continuous
Ampere LSIG LSIA Fixed Rating Plug
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Rating Number
2
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity Current Limiting 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
125 LDC3125T106W LDC3125T107W 70 ORPL125A070
2 90 ORPL125A090
100 ORPL125A100
2 110 ORPL125A110
125 ORPL125A125
2 250 LDC3250T106W LDC3250T107W 125 ORPL025A125
2 150
175
ORPL025A150
ORPL025A175
2 200 ORPL025A200
225 ORPL025A225
2 250 ORPL025A250
400 LDC3400T106W LDC3400T107W 200 ORPL40A200
2 225 ORPL40A225
2 250
300
ORPL40A250
ORPL40A300
2 350 ORPL40A350
400 ORPL40A400
2 600 LDC3600T106W LDC3600T107W 300 ORPL60A300
2
350 ORPL60A350
400 ORPL60A400
2 500 ORPL60A500
600 ORPL60A600
2 Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 2 One Form C auxiliary switch and one Form C bell alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
3 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes 2
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 550 Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
2 Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip OPTIM Rating Plug Only
2 L
S
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
2 G
A
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
2
OPTIM 550 2
Continuous
Ampere LSI LSIG LSIA Fixed Rating Plug
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Number Rating Number
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
125 CHLD3125T52W CHLD3125T56W CHLD3125T57W 70 ORPL125A070
2 90 ORPL125A090
100 ORPL125A100
2 110 ORPL125A125
125 ORPL125A125
2 250 CHLD3250T52W CHLD3250T56W CHLD3250T57W 125 ORPL025A125
2 150
175
ORPL025A150
ORPL025A175
2 200 ORPL025A200
225 ORPL025A225
2 250 ORPL025A250
400 CHLD3400T52W CHLD3400T56W CHLD3400T57W 200 ORPL40A200
2 225 ORPL40A225
2 250
350
ORPL40A250
ORPL40A350
2 400 ORPL40A400
600 CHLD3600T52W CHLD3600T56W CHLD3600T57W 300 ORPL60A300
2 350 ORPL60A350
2
400 ORPL60A400
500 ORPL60A500
2 600 ORPL60A600
Notes
2 1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Number Rating Number
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity Current Limiting 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
125 CLDC3125T52W CLDC3125T56W CLDC3125T57W 70 ORPL125A070
2
90 ORPL125A090
2
100 ORPL125A100
110 ORPL125A110 2
125 ORPL125A125
250 CLDC3250T52W CLDC3250T56W CLDC3250T57W 125 ORPL025A125 2
2
150 ORPL025A150
175 ORPL025A175
200 ORPL025A200
2
225 ORPL025A225
250 ORPL025A250 2
400 CLDC3400T52W CLDC3400T56W CLDC3400T57W 200 ORPL40A200
225 ORPL40A225 2
250
300
ORPL40A250
ORPL40A300
2
350 ORPL40A350 2
400 ORPL40A400
600 CLDC3600T52W CLDC3600T56W CLDC3600T57W 300 ORPL60A300 2
350 ORPL60A350
400 ORPL60A400
2
500 ORPL60A500
2
600 ORPL60A600
Notes 2
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug
2 Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip OPTIM Rating Plug Only
2 L
S
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
2 G
A
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
2
OPTIM 1050 23
Continuous
Ampere LSIG LSIA Fixed Rating Plug
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Rating Number
2
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 35 kAIC at 480 Vac
125 CLD3125T106W CLD3125T107W 70 ORPL125A070
2 90 ORPL125A090
100 ORPL125A100
2 110 ORPL125A110
125 ORPL125A125
2 250 CLD3250T106W CLD3250T107W 125 ORPL025A125
2 150
175
ORPL025A150
ORPL025A175
2 200 ORPL025A200
225 ORPL025A225
2 250 ORPL025A250
400 CLD3400T106W CLD3400T107W 200 ORPL40A200
2 225 ORPL40A225
2 250
300
ORPL40A250
ORPL40A300
2 350 ORPL40A350
400 ORPL40A400
2 600 CLD3600T106W CLD3600T107W 300 ORPL60A300
2
350 ORPL60A350
400 ORPL60A400
2 500 ORPL60A500
600 ORPL60A600
2 Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 2 One Form C auxiliary switch and one Form C bell alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
3 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 One Form C auxiliary switch and one Form C bell alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
2
2
3 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breaker with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
2 Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip OPTIM Rating Plug Only
2 L
S
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
2 G
A
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
2
OPTIM 1050 23
Continuous
Ampere LSIG LSIA Fixed Rating Plug
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Rating Number
2
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity Current Limiting 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
125 CLDC3125T106W CLDC3125T107W 70 ORPL125A070
2 90 ORPL125A090
100 ORPL125A100
2 110 ORPL125A110
125 ORPL125A125
2 250 CLDC3250T106W CLDC3250T107W 125 ORPL025A125
2 150
175
ORPL025A150
ORPL025A175
2 200 ORPL025A200
225 ORPL025A225
2 250 ORPL025A250
400 CLDC3400T106W CLDC3400T107W 200 ORPL40A200
2 225 ORPL40A225
2 250
300
ORPL40A250
ORPL40A300
2 350 ORPL40A350
400 ORPL40A400
2 600 CLDC3600T106W CLDC3600T107W 300 ORPL60A300
2
350 ORPL60A350
400 ORPL60A400
2 500 ORPL60A500
600 ORPL60A600
2 Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 2 One Form C auxiliary switch and one Form C bell alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
3 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Warning Label
2
Retainer 2
Screws
2
Circuit Breaker
Line Terminal Cover 2
2
Line and Load Terminals
Terminals with
2
2
Maximum Terminal AWG Wire Terminal Control Wire Termination
Breaker Body Wire Range/Number Metric Wire Catalog Catalog
Amperes Material Type of Conductors Range mm2 Poles Number Number
Standard Cu/AI Pressure Terminals 2
400
400
Aluminum
Aluminum
Cu/AI
Cu/AI
4/0600 (1)
4/0600 (1)
120300
120300
Two-pole kit 1
Three-pole kit 1
2TA401LDK
3TA401LDK
2
400 Aluminum Cu/AI 4/0600 (1) 120300 Four-pole kit 1 4TA401LDK 2
2
450 Aluminum Cu/AI 44/0 (2) 2595 TA450LD
500 Aluminum Cu/AI 3/0350 (2) 95150 2
TA602LD TA602LDCW 2
600 Aluminum Cu/AI 400500 (2) 185240 Two-pole kit 1 2TA603LDK 2TA603LDKCW
600 Aluminum Cu/AI 400500 (2) 185240 Three-pole kit 1 3TA603LDK 3TA603LDKCW
2
600 Aluminum Cu/AI 400500 (2) 185240 Four-pole kit 1 4TA603LDK 4TA603LDKCW
2
Optional Copper and Cu/AI Pressure Type Terminals
600 Copper Cu 250350 (2) 120250 2
T602LD T602LDCW 2
2
Notes
1 Terminal kits contain one terminal for each pole and one terminal cover.
2 Individually packed.
Accessories
2
Allowable Accessory Combinations
2 Different combinations of accessories can be supplied, depending on the types of accessories and the number of poles
in the circuit breaker.
2
LD Frame Accessories
2 Reference Two-Pole 1, Three-Pole Four-Pole
Description Page Left Center Right Left Center Right Neutral 2
2 Internal Accessories (Only One Internal Accessory Per Pole) 3
Legend
2 1 Two-pole breaker supplied in three-pole frame. Current carrying parts omitted from center pole.
2 Refer to Eaton for appropriate neutral pole accessory combinations.
3 OPTIM model 1050 is factory sealed and does not have the right pole space available for accessories.
2 4 Shunt trip and UVR cannot be mounted in right poles on LES or OPTIM trip units. Standard non-tripping internal accessories can be mounted in the left or right poles of LES and 550 OPTIM trip units.
2
2
2
Notes
1 Two-pole breaker supplied in three-pole frame. Current carrying parts omitted from center pole.
2 Refer to Eaton for appropriate neutral pole accessory combinations.
2
2
3 MTST230V applies to 100230 Vac.
4 Included with all LD LSG and LSIG trip units and breakers.
5 Includes 6 ft cable for remote mounting; NEMA 3R rated.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 LDB 2, 3 65 35 25 22
LD 2, 3, 4 65 35 25 22
2 CLD 4 2, 3, 4 65 35 25
HLD, HLDB 2, 3, 4 100 65 35 25
2 CHLD 4 2, 3, 4 100 65 35
2 LDC, LDCB 5
CLDC 45
2, 3, 4
2, 3, 4
200
200
100
100
50
50
30
2
IEC 947-2 Interrupting Capacity Ratings 1
2 LDC
LDC
240 V/200 kA
480 V/100 kA
64.80
66.90
6.80
9.33
Notes
2 1 Utilization Category A circuit breakers.
2 L/R = 8 milliseconds minimum.
2 3 Two-pole circuit breaker or two poles of three-pole circuit breaker. Incorporating thermal-magnetic trip unit only.
4 100% rated breakers.
2
5 Current limiting.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
(310+ with Maintenance ModeALSI and ALSIG)
Notes
1 B2x suffixes cannot be combined with B2x suffixes.
2 Not available for LD. Independently adjustable Ii setting available in LG, NG, and RG ALSI and
2
2
ALSIG trip units.
2 Protection
Ordering options LSI, LSI(A), LSIG LSI(A), LSIG
2
Adjustable rating plug (In) No No
Long delay pickup 0.41.0 x (In) 0.41.0 x (In)
2
Short delay pickup 150800% x (Ir) 150800% x (Ir)
Short delay time I2t 100500 ms 100500 ms
2 Instantaneous override
Ground Fault Protection (G)
Yes Yes
Legend
2 BIM = Breaker Interface Module
(A) = GF Alarm
Is = Sensor Rating
2 In = Rating Plug
Ir = Long Delay Pickup Setting
2 Note
1 Zone interlock kit.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Legend
2
2
BIM = Breaker Interface Module
(A) = GF Alarm
Is = Sensor Rating
2
In = Rating Plug
Ir = Long Delay Pickup Setting
Notes
1 Zone interlock kit. 2
2 By OPTIMizer/BIM.
3 Eatons PowerNet kit.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 LD Frame
Number of Poles Width Height Depth
2 2, 3 8.25 (209.6) 10.75 (273.1) 4.06 (103.1)
2 Side View
2 3.44
(87.3)
1.72
2
(43.7)
CL Breaker
3.28
2 CL Handle
1.33
(83.3)
(33.7)2.29
2 0.25 (6.4) R (58.2)
10.75 8.21
(273.1) (208.6)
2
1.50
(38.1)
3.64
2
(92.5) 7.28 0.19 R
(184.9) (4.8) R
2
2 8.25
(209.6)
2
2 Approximate Shipping Weight, Lbs (kg)
2 LD Frame
Complete Breaker Frame Only Trip Unit
2 Breaker
Type Two-Pole Three-Pole Four-Pole Two-Pole Three-Pole Four-Pole Two-Pole Three-Pole Four-Pole
2 LD, HLD, LDC 18 (8.2) 20 (9.1) 25 (11.3) 14 (6.4) 15 (6.8) 20 (9.1) 3 (1.4) 4 (1.8) 5 (2.3)
LDB 18 (8.2) 20 (9.1) 25 (11.3)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 MDL 3 800 F
2 Circuit Breaker/ Suffix
2
Frame Type Number Circuit Breaker/ F = Frame only (800 A only)
MDL, MDLB of Poles Frame Ampere Rating K = High magnetic molded case switch
HMDL, HMDLB 2 = Two-pole 300 1 500 V = 50 C (thermal-magnetic trip units only)
2 3 = Three-pole 350 1 600
700
W
X
=
=
Without terminals
Load side terminals only
400
MT 3 800 T
2
2 Trip Unit Type
MT Number Trip Unit Rating/ T
Suffix
= Thermal-magnetic
of Poles Plug Ampere Rating
2
V = 50 C (thermal-magnetic trip units only)
2 = Two-pole 300 1 500
3 = Three-pole 350 1 600
2 400
450
700
800
2
2 310+ Electronic Trip Unit 1
2
MES Number Trip Unit Blank = No feature
of Poles LS = 310+ Electronic LS B20 = High load alarm
3 = Three-pole Amperes LSI = 310+ Electronic LSI B21 = Ground fault alarm, with trip
2 800 LSG =
LSIG =
310+ Electronic LSG
310+ Electronic LSIG
B22 =
ZG =
Ground fault alarm, no trip
Zone selective interlocking
2
ALSI = 310+ Electronic LSI with Maintenance Mode
ALSIG = 310+ Electronic LSIG with Maintenance Mode
2 Note
1 Frames are the same for thermal-magnetic or 310+ electronic trip units, e.g., MDL3800F, HMDL3800F, etc.
2
300 MDL2300 MDL2800F HMDL2300 HMDL2800F MT2300T TA700MA1
350 MDL2350 HMDL2350 MT2350T TA700MA1
400 MDL2400 HMDL2400 MT2400T TA700MA1
2
450 MDL2450 HMDL2450 MT2450T TA700MA1
500 MDL2500 HMDL2500 MT2500T TA700MA1 2
600 MDL2600 HMDL2600 MT2600T TA700MA1
700 MDL2700 HMDL2700 MT2700T TA700MA1 2
800 MDL2800 HMDL2800 MT2800T TA800MA2
2
Types MDL and HMDL Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Trip UnitsThree-Pole
2
Standard Interrupting Capacity
600 Vac Rated 50 kAIC at 480 Vac
High Interrupting Capacity
600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit Only 2
For Use with Standard
or High or Ultra High
2
2
Interrupting Frames Standard
Terminals
Magnetic Trip Range Only 1
Maximum
Factory Assembled
Circuit Consisting
Factory Assembled
Circuit Consisting
is 510 Up Through
600 A; 48 on 700 and See Page 2
Continuous of Frame, Trip Unit of Frame, Trip Unit 800 A x Continuous V4-T2-217 for
Ampere and Terminals Frame Only and Terminals Frame Only Ampere Rating Optional Terminals 2
Rating Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Number Number Number Number
2
300 MDL3300 MDL3800F HMDL3300 HMDL3800F MT3300T TA700MA1
350 MDL3350 HMDL3350 MT3400T TA700MA1 2
400 MDL3400 HMDL3400 MT3400T TA700MA1
450 MDL3450 HMDL3450 MT3450T TA700MA1 2
2
500 MDL3500 HMDL3500 MT3500T TA700MA1
600 MDL3600 HMDL3600 MT3600T TA700MA1
700 MDL3700 HMDL3700 MT3700T TA700MA1
2
800 MDL3800 HMDL3800 MT3800T TA800MA2
Note 2
1 Two terminals are required per pole.
2
2
2
2
2
2
Types MDLB and HMDLB Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with Non-Interchangeable Trip UnitsTwo-Pole 1
2 Standard Interrupting Capacity High Interrupting Capacity Standard Terminals Only 2
600 Vac Rated 50 kAIC at 480 Vac 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
2 Maximum
Continuous Factory Assembled Circuit Consisting Factory Assembled Circuit Consisting See Page V4-T2-217 for
Ampere of Frame, Trip Unit and Terminals of Frame, Trip Unit and Terminals Optional Terminals
2 Rating
at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
450 MDLB2450 HMDLB2450 TA700MA1
500 MDLB2500 HMDLB2500 TA700MA1
2
Types MDLB and HMDLB Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with Non-Interchangeable Trip UnitsThree-Pole 1
2 Standard Interrupting Capacity High Interrupting Capacity Standard Terminals Only 2
600 Vac Rated 50 kAIC at 480 Vac 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
2
Maximum
Continuous Factory Assembled Circuit Consisting Factory Assembled Circuit Consisting See Page V4-T2-217 for
Ampere of Frame, Trip Unit and Terminals of Frame, Trip Unit and Terminals Optional Terminals
2 Rating
at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
600 MDLB3600 HMDLB3600 TA700MA1
700 MDLB3700 HMDLB3700 TA700MA1
Notes
2 1 Factory sealed for reverse feed application.
2 Two terminals are required per pole.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Maximum
Interrupting
Capacity 600 Vac
High Interrupting
Capacity 600 Vac Adjustable Short
Independently
Adjustable Short
Time Pickup with I2t
Short Delay and
Adjustable Short
Time Pickup and
2
Rated 50 kAIC at Rated 65 kAIC at Time Pickup with I2t Time Pickup and Ground Fault Ground Fault Neutral CT for
2
Continuous
Ampere 480 Vac 480 Vac Short Delay Ramp Delay Protection Protection LSG and LSIG 23
Rating Catalog Catalog Terminal
at 40 C Number Number Catalog Number Catalog Number Information
2
800 MDL3800F HMDL3800F MES3800LS MES3800LSI MES3800LSG MES3800LSIG LGFCT600 See Page
V4-T2-218
2
2
Types MDLB and HMDLB Electronic Circuit Breakers with Non-Interchangeable 310+ Trip Units 4
Factory-Assembled Circuit Breaker Consisting of Frame and Trip Unit Less Terminals
LS LSI LSG LSIG
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere Adjustable Short Time Pickup Independently Adjustable
Adjustable Short Time Pickup Independently Adjustable
with I2t Short Delay and Short Time Pickup and Ground Neutral CT for 2
Rating with I2t Short Delay Ramp Short Time Pickup and Delay Ground Fault Protection Fault Protection LSG and LSIG 23
at 40 C Catalog Number Catalog Number 2
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 50 kAIC at 480 Vac
800 MDLB3800FT33W MDLB3800FT32W MDLB3800FT35W MDLB3800FT36W LGFCT600 2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
800 HMDLB3800FT33W HMDLB3800FT32W HMDLB3800FT35W HMDLB3800FT36W LGFCT600
2
100% Rated Types CMDL and CHMDL Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Trip Units
2
The NEC allows the breaker to be rated at 100% of its frame size in an assembly, provided that 90 C wire is applied at the 75 C
ampacity. All 100% rated circuit breakers have electronic trip units. Order as individual components: breaker frame, trip unit and 2
terminals. See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-220.
2
100% Rated Types CMDL and CHMDL Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable 310+ Trip UnitsThree-Pole
Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip RMS 310+ Trip Unit Only 1 2
Standard Options
Standard High LS LSI LSG LSIG 2
Interrupting Interrupting Adjustable Short Independently
Maximum
Continuous
Capacity
600 Vac Rated
Capacity
600 Vac Rated Adjustable Short
Independently
Adjustable Short
Time Pickup with I2t
Short Delay and
Adjustable Short
Time Pickup and
2
50 kAIC at 65 kAIC at 2
Time Pickup with I t Time Pickup and Ground Fault Ground Fault Neutral CT for
Ampere
Rating 480 Vac 480 Vac Short Delay Ramp Delay Protection Protection LSG and LSIG 23 Terminal 2
at 40 C Catalog Number Catalog Number Information
800 CMDL3800F CHMDL3800F MES3800LS MES3800LSI MES3800LSG MES3800LSIG LGFCT600 See Page V4-T2-218 2
Notes
1 For AC use only.
2
2
2 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired.
3 Included with LSG and LSIG trip units or breakers.
4 Factory sealed, suitable for reverse feed application. CMDLB and CHMDLB are also available.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 Maximum
Continuous
Circuit Breaker Only without
Line and Load Terminals
2
Ampere Rating Catalog
at 40 C Number
2
Two-Pole
800 MDL2800WK
2 MDLB2800WK 1
HMDL2800WK
2 Three-Pole
800 MDL3800WK
2 MDLB3800WK 1
2 HMDL3800WK
Notes
2 1 MDLB and HMDLB are suitable for reverse feed applications.
Accessories
2
Allowable Accessory Combinations
2 Different combinations of accessories can be supplied, depending on the types of accessories and the number of poles in the
circuit breaker.
2
MD Frame Accessories
2 Reference Two-Pole 1 Three-Pole
Description Page Left Right Left Center Right
2 Internal Accessories (Only One Internal Accessory Per Pole)
2
Alarm lockout (Make/Break) V4-T2-276
Alarm lockout (2Make/2Break) V4-T2-276
2
External Accessories
Rear fed terminals V4-T2-312
2 Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
2 May be mounted on left or right polenot both
Accessory available/modification available
2 Notes
1 Two-pole breaker supplied in three-pole frame. Current carrying parts omitted from center pole.
2 2 Shunt trip and UVR cannot be mounted in right poles on MES trip units.
2
2
Notes 2
1 MTST230V applies to 100230 Vac.
2 Included with all LD LSG and LSIG trip units and breakers. 2
3 Includes 6 ft cable for remote mounting; NEMA 3R rated.
4 Utilization Category A circuit breakers.
5 Two-pole or two poles of three-pole circuit breaker. Thermal-magnetic trip units only, MDL, HMDL breakers with electronic trip unit are not DC rated.
2
2
6 Time constant is 3 milliseconds minimum at 10 kA and 8 milliseconds at 22 kA.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
E 600
100% rated Yes
F 630
Protection
2 Ordering options LS, LSI, LSG, LSIG, ALSI, ALSIG
G 700
H (= In) 800
2
Arcflash Reduction Maintenance System Remote enabled on ALSI, ALSIG
(or Maintenance Mode) tr = long delay time (seconds) 2 2
(All 310+)
Interchangeable trip unit Yes 4 4
2 High load alarm (suffix B20) 1 Yes 7 7
2
Isd (x Ir) = short delay pickup Position 1 2x
(All 310+)
Position 2 3x
2 Position 3 4x
Position 4 5x
2 Position 5 6x
Position 6 7x
2 Position 7 8x
2
Position 8 8x
Position 9 8x
2
Position 3 320
Position 4 480
2 Position 5 640
Position 6 800
2 tg = ground fault delay time (milliseconds) Position 1 Inst
(LSG, LSIG, ALSIG)
Position 2 120
2 Position 3 300
2
2
Independently adjustable Instantaneous (Ii) setting
Maintenance Mode pickup (2.5 x In) (amperes) Fixed 2000
2
(310+ with Maintenance ModeALSI and ALSIG)
Notes
2 1 B2x suffixes cannot be combined with B2x suffixes.
2 Not available for MDL. Independently adjustable Ii setting available in LG, NG, and RG ALSI
2
and ALSIG trip units.
Drilling Plan
2
Front View Side View
3.44
2
(87.3)
1.72
(43.7) 2
CL Breaker R 0.25
(6.4) 2
2
3.28 16.00
2
R 0.19 CL Handle 1.33 (83.3) (406.4)
(4.8) (33.7)
2
1.50
(38.1)
0.97 2
(24.6)
2
3.64
(92.5)
7.28 8.25 4.06
2
2
(184.9) (209.6) (103.2)
2
Approximate Shipping Weight, Lbs (kg)
MD Frame 2
Breaker Type
Complete Breaker
Two-Pole Three-Pole
Frame Only
Two-Pole Three-Pole
Trip Unit 1
Two-Pole Three-Pole
2
MDL, HMDL (T/M T.U.) 26.5 (12.0) 29.0 (13.2) 24.5 (11.1) 26.0 (11.8) 2.5 (1.1) 3.0 (1.4) 2
MDL, HMDL (Elec. T.U.) 30.0 (13.6) 26.0 (11.8) 4.0 (1.8)
Note
2
2
1 Thermal-magnetic only.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Contents
2 Typical N-Frame Breaker
Description Page
2 Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-116
Standards and Certifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-117
2 Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-118
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-121
2 F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-135
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-153
2 K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-161
V4-T2-185
2 M-Frame (300800 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes)
V4-T2-211
2
2 N-Frame (4001200 Amperes)
2 Product Description
All Eaton N-Frame circuit
2 breakers are suitable for
reverse feed use
2
All N-Frame circuit
breakers are HACR rated
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
Digitrip OPTIM Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
2 Order as individual components: breaker frame (which includes trip unit), rating plug, terminals.
2
Digitrip OPTIM 550 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
2 Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip OPTIM Rating Plug Only
L Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
2 S Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
2 G
A
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum OPTIM 550 2
2 Continuous Fixed
Ampere LSI LSIG LSIA Rating Plug
Rating Catalog Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
2 at 40 C Number Number Number Rating Number
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 50 kAIC at 480 Vac
2 800 ND3800T52W ND3800T56W ND3800T57W 400 ORPN80A400
2 450
500
ORPN80A450
ORPN80A500
2 550 ORPN80A550
600 ORPN80A600
2 700 ORPN80A700
800 ORPN80A800
2 1200 ND312T52W ND312T56W ND312T57W 600 ORPN12A600
2 700
800
ORPN12A700
ORPN12A800
2 1000 ORPN12A100
1200 ORPN12A120
2 Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
2
800 HND3800T52W HND3800T56W HND3800T57W 400 ORPN80A400
450 ORPN80A450
2 500 ORPN80A500
550 ORPN80A550
2 600 ORPN80A600
700 ORPN80A700
2 800 ORPN80A800
2
1200 HND312T52W HND312T56W HND312T57W 600 ORPN12A600
700 ORPN12A700
2 800 ORPN12A800
1000 ORPN12A100
2 1200 ORPN12A120
2 Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Number Rating Number
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
800 NDC3800T52W NDC3800T56W NDC3800T57W 400 ORPN80A400
2
450 ORPN80A450
2
500 ORPN80A500
550 ORPN80A550 2
600 ORPN80A600
700 ORPN80A700 2
2
800 ORPN80A800
1200 NDC312T52W NDC312T56W NDC312T57W 600 ORPN12A600
700 ORPN12A700
2
800 ORPN12A800
1000 ORPN12A100 2
1200 ORPN12A120
Notes
2
2
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
2 Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip OPTIM Rating Plug Only
2 L Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
S Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
2 G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
2
OPTIM 1050 23 Fixed
Continuous
Ampere LSIG LSIA Rating Plug
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Rating Number
2
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 50 kAIC at 480 Vac
800 ND3800T106W ND3800T107W 400 ORPN80A400
2 450 ORPN80A450
500 ORPN80A500
2 550 ORPN80A550
600 ORPN80A600
2 700 ORPN80A700
2 700 ORPN12A700
800 ORPN12A800
2 1000 ORPN12A100
1200 ORPN12A120
2 Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
2 500 ORPN80A500
550 ORPN80A550
2 600 ORPN80A600
2
700 ORPN80A700
800 ORPN80A800
2
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
800 NDC3800T106W NDC3800T107W 400 ORPN80A400
2 450 ORPN80A450
500 ORPN80A500
2 550 ORPN80A550
600 ORPN80A600
2 700 ORPN80A700
2 700 ORPN12A700
800 ORPN12A800
2 1000 ORPN12A100
2
1200 ORPN12A120
Notes
2 1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 One Form C auxiliary switch and one Form C bell (trip) alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
3 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 550 Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs, continued
2 Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip OPTIM Rating Plug Only
2 L
S
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
2 G
A
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
2
OPTIM 550 2 Fixed
Continuous
Ampere LSI LSIG LSIA Rating Plug
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Number Rating Number
2
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
800 CNDC3800T52W CNDC3800T56W CNDC3800T57W 400 ORPN80A400
2 450 ORPN80A450
500 ORPN80A500
2 550 ORPN80A550
600 ORPN80A600
2 700 ORPN80A700
2 700 ORPN12A700
800 ORPN12A800
2 1000 ORPN12A100
1200 ORPN12A120
2 Notes
2
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
3 Includes conductor extension kit, which increases breaker length 3.75 on each end. Terminal ordered separate.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Rating Number
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 50 kAIC at 480 Vac
800 CND3800T106W CND3800T107W 400 ORPN80A400
2
450 ORPN80A450
2
500 ORPN80A500
550 ORPN80A550 2
600 ORPN80A600
700 ORPN80A700 2
2
800 ORPN80A800
1200 CND312T106W CND312T107W 600 ORPN12A600
700 ORPN12A700
2
800 ORPN12A800
1000 ORPN12A100 2
1200 ORPN12A120
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac 2
800 CHND3800T106W CHND3800T107W 400
450
ORPN80A400
ORPN80A450
2
550 ORPN80A550 2
600 ORPN80A600
700 ORPN80A700 2
800 ORPN80A800
1200 CHND312T106W CHND312T107W 600 ORPN12A600
2
700 ORPN12A700
2
800 ORPN12A800
1000 ORPN12A100 2
1200 ORPN12A120
Notes
2
2
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 One Form C auxiliary switch one Form C bell (trip) alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
3 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs, continued
2 Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip OPTIM Rating Plug Only
2 L
S
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
2 G
A
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
2
OPTIM 1050 23 Fixed
Continuous
Ampere LSIG LSIA Rating Plug
2
Rating Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Rating Number
2
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
800 CNDC3800T106W CNDC3800T107W 400 ORPN80A400
2 450 ORPN80A450
500 ORPN80A500
2 550 ORPN80A550
600 ORPN80A600
2 700 ORPN80A700
2 700 ORPN12A700
800 ORPN12A800
2 1000 ORPN12A100
1200 ORPN12A120
2
Type ND Molded Case Switches
2
Type ND High Instantaneous (K)
2 Continuous Three-Pole Four-Pole 5
Ampere Rating Catalog Catalog
2 at 40 C Number Number
800 ND3800WK ND4800WK
2 HND3800WK HND4800WK
2
1200 ND312WK ND412WK
HND312WK HND412WK
2 Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 2 One Form C auxiliary switch one Form C bell (trip) alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
3 Factory sealed.
2
4 Includes conductor extension kit, which increases breaker length 3.75 on each end. Terminal ordered separate.
5 Neutral is in right pole.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Terminal rating is AL9CU.
2 Terminal rating is AL7CU.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Accessories
2
Allowable Accessory Combinations
2 Different combinations of accessories can be supplied, depending on the types of accessories and the number of poles in the
circuit breaker.
2
ND Frame Accessories
2 Reference Three-Pole Four-Pole
Description Page Left Center Right Left Center Right Neutral
2 Internal Accessories (Only One Internal Accessory Per Pole) 1
2 External Accessories
Base mounting hardware V4-T2-313
2 Interphase barriers V4-T2-315
Terminal shield V4-T2-315
2 Non-padlockable handle block V4-T2-316
2 Padlockable handle lock hasp
Key interlock kit
V4-T2-317
V4-T2-318
2
Breaker interface module (BIM) V4-T2-327
Digitrip OPTIMizer V4-T2-327
2 Special calibration
Moisture fungus treatment V4-T2-116
2 Freeze-tested circuit breakers
Marine/naval application
2 Legend
2
1 OPTIM 550 and 1050 are factory sealed and do not have the right pole available for accessories.
Icu 2, 3, 4 100 70 25
Ics 2, 3, 4 100 50 13
2
NDC
Icu 2, 3, 4 200 100 35 2
Ics 2, 3, 4 100 50 18
CNDC 2 2
Icu
Ics
2, 3, 4
2, 3, 4
200
100
100
50
35
18
2
Notes 2
1 Utilization Category A circuit breakers.
2 100% rated breakers.
3 800 amperes maximum rating.
2
2
4 Successfully tested at 300 kAIC, although UL recognizes maximum of 200 kAIC at 240 Vac.
5 Successfully tested at 75 kAIC, although UL recognizes maximum of 65 kAIC at 600 Vac.
2
2
2
2
2
2
N-Frame Digitrip
2 Trip Unit Type Digitrip OPTIM 550 Digitrip OPTIM 1050
2 Protection
Ordering options LSI, LSIG, LSI(A) LSI(A), LISG
2
Adjustable rating plug (In) No No
Long delay pickup 0.41.0 x (In) 0.41.0 x (In)
2
Short delay pickup 150800% x (Ir) 150800% x (Ir)
Short delay time I2t 100500 ms 100500 ms
2 Instantaneous override
Ground Fault Protection (G)
Yes Yes
2
Remote signal contactground alarm Yes 1 Yes
Local auxiliary and bell alarm contact Optional Included
2 Legend
BIM = Breaker Interface Module
2 (A) = GF Alarm
Is = Sensor Rating
In = Rating Plug
2 Ir = Long Delay Pickup Setting
Note
2
1 Zone interlock kit.
2
2
2
Legend 2
BIM = Breaker Interface Module
(A) = GF Alarm
Is = Sensor Rating
2
In = Rating Plug
Ir = Long Delay Pickup Setting 2
Notes
1 By OPTIMizer/BIM.
2 Eatons PowerNet kit.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
ND Frame
2 Number of Poles Width Height Depth
2 3.44
(87.3)
2 1.72
(43.6)
0.25 R
2 (6.4 R)
1.91
CL Handle
2 (48.4)
CL Handle
16.00
(406.4) ON/I
2 3.68 0.19 R
(4.8 R)
(93.2) OFF/O
2 1.50
(38.1)
2 3.19
(80.9) 6.38
2
(161.9)
8.25 5.50
(209.6) (139.7)
2
2 Approximate Shipping Weight in Lbs (kg)
2 ND Frame
2
Complete Breaker
Breaker Type Two-Pole Three-Pole Four-Pole
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 RD 3 16 T53 W
2 Circuit Breaker/ Suffix
Frame Type Number W = Without terminals
2 RD of Poles Circuit Breaker/Frame Trip Type 1 P = 100% protected neutral pole
RDC 3 = Three-pole Ampere Rating T53 = Digitrip RMS 510 LS R = Ground fault remote (310 only)
2 CRD 2
CRDC 2
4 = Four-pole 16 = 1600 amperes
20 = 2000 amperes
T65
T86
= Digitrip RMS 610 LSG
= Digitrip RMS 810 LSIG
K = Molded case switch
2 Notes
1 For complete list of available trip types, refer to Pages V4-T2-239 to V4-T2-248.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip Rating Plug Only
L Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time
S Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I 2t or Flat Response)
2 Maximum
Continuous
I
G
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Ampere Rated Fixed
2 Rating
at 40 C
LI
Catalog Number
LS LSI LIG LSG LSIG Current
(In)
Rating Plug
Catalog Number
2 Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600 CRD316T51W CRD316T53W CRD316T52W CRD316T54W CRD316T55W CRD316T56W 800 RP6R16A080
2 1000 RP6R16A100
1200 RP6R16A120
2 1600 RP6R16A160
2 1600 RP6R20A160
2000 RP6R20A200
2 Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
2
1600 CRDC316T53W CRDC316T52W CRDC316T54W CRDC316T55W CRDC316T56W 800 RP6R16A080
1000 RP6R16A100
2 1200 RP6R16A120
1600 RP6R16A160
2 2000 1 CRDC320T51W CRDC320T53W CRDC320T52W CRDC320T54W CRDC320T55W CRDC320T56W 1000 RP6R20A100
1200 RP6R20A120
2 1600 RP6R20A160
2
2000 RP6R20A200
Note
2 1 Includes B2016RDL rear connectors.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
2500 RP6R25A250
2
1600 RDC316T61W RDC316T63W RDC316T62W RDC316T64W RDC316T65W RDC316T66W 800 RP6R16A080 2
1000 RP6R16A100
1200 RP6R16A120 2
2
1600 RP6R16A160
2000 RDC320T61W RDC320T63W RDC320T62W RDC320T64W RDC320T65W RDC320T66W 1000 RP6R20A100
1200 RP6R20A120
2
1600 RP6R20A160
2000 RP6R20A200 2
2500 RDC325T61W RDC325T63W RDC325T62W RDC325T64W RDC325T65W RDC325T66W 1600 RP6R25A160
2000 RP6R25A200 2
2500 RP6R25A250
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip Rating Plug Only
L Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time
S Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
2 Maximum
Continuous
I
G
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Ampere Rated Fixed
2 Rating
at 40 C
LI
Catalog Number
LS LSI LIG LSG LSIG Current
(In)
Rating Plug
Catalog Number
2 Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600 CRD316T61W CRD316T63W CRD316T62W CRD316T64W CRD316T65W CRD316T66W 800 RP6R16A080
2 1000 RP6R16A100
1200 RP6R16A120
2 1600 RP6R16A160
2 1600 RP6R20A160
2000 RP6R20A200
2 Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
2
1600 CRDC316T61W CRDC316T63W CRDC316T62W CRDC316T64W CRDC316T65W CRDC316T66W 800 RP6R16A080
1000 RP6R16A100
2 1200 RP6R16A120
1600 RP6R16A160
2 2000 1 CRDC320T61W CRDC320T63W CRDC320T62W CRDC320T64W CRDC320T65W CRDC320T66W 1000 RP6R20A100
1200 RP6R20A120
2 1600 RP6R20A160
2
2000 RP6R20A200
Note
2 1 Includes B2016RDL rear connectors.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
2500 RP6R25A250
2
1600 RDC316T81W RDC316T83W RDC316T82W RDC316T84W RDC316T85W RDC316T86W 800 RP6R16A080 2
1000 RP6R16A100
1200 RP6R16A120 2
2
1600 RP6R16A160
2000 RDC320T81W RDC320T83W RDC320T82W RDC320T84W RDC320T85W RDC320T86W 1000 RP6R20A100
1200 RP6R20A120
2
1600 RP6R20A160
2000 RP6R20A200 2
2500 RDC325T81W RDC325T83W RDC325T82W RDC325T84W RDC325T85W RDC325T86W 1600 RP6R25A160
2000 RP6R25A200 2
2500 RP6R25A250
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip Rating Plug Only
L Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time
S Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
2 Maximum
Continuous
I
G
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Ampere Rated Fixed
2 Rating
at 40 C
LI
Catalog Number
LS LSI LIG LSG LSIG Current
(In)
Rating Plug
Catalog Number
2 Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600 CRD316T81W CRD316T83W CRD316T82W CRD316T84W CRD316T85W CRD316T86W 800 RP6R16A080
2 1000 RP6R16A100
1200 RP6R16A120
2 1600 RP6R16A160
2 1600 RP6R20A160
2000 RP6R20A200
2 Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
2
1600 CRDC316T81W CRDC316T83W CRDC316T82W CRDC316T84W CRDC316T85W CRDC316T86W 800 RP6R16A080
1000 RP6R16A100
2 1200 RP6R16A120
1600 RP6R16A160
2 2000 1 CRDC320T81W CRDC320T83W CRDC320T82W CRDC320T84W CRDC320T85W CRDC320T86W 1000 RP6R20A100
1200 RP6R20A120
2 1600 RP6R20A160
2
2000 RP6R20A200
Note
2 1 Includes B2016RDL rear connectors.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
2500 RP6R25A250
2
1600 RDC316T91W RDC316T93W RDC316T92W RDC316T94W RDC316T95W RDC316T96W 800 RP6R16A080 2
1000 RP6R16A100
1200 RP6R16A120 2
2
1600 RP6R16A160
2000 RDC320T91W RDC320T93W RDC320T92W RDC320T94W RDC320T95W RDC320T96W 1000 RP6R20A100
1200 RP6R20A120
2
1600 RP6R20A160
2000 RP6R20A200 2
2500 RDC325T91W RDC325T93W RDC325T92W RDC325T94W RDC325T95W RDC325T96W 1600 RP6R25A160
2000 RP6R25A200 2
2500 RP6R25A250
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip Rating Plug Only
L Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time
S Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I 2t or Flat Response)
2 Maximum
Continuous
I
G
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Ampere Rated Fixed
2 Rating
at 40 C
LI
Catalog Number
LS LSI LIG LSG LSIG Current
(In)
Rating Plug
Catalog Number
2 Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600 CRD316T91W CRD316T93W CRD316T92W CRD316T94W CRD316T95W CRD316T96W 800 RP6R16A080
2 1000 RP6R16A100
1200 RP6R16A120
2 1600 RP6R16A160
2 1600 RP6R20A160
2000 RP6R20A200
2 Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
2
1600 CRDC316T91W CRDC316T93W CRDC316T92W CRDC316T94W CRDC316T95W CRDC316T96W 800 RP6R16A080
1000 RP6R16A100
2 1000 RP6R16A100
1200 RP6R16A120
2 2000 1 CRDC320T91W CRDC320T93W CRDC320T92W CRDC320T94W CRDC320T95W CRDC320T96W 1000 RP6R20A100
1200 RP6R20A120
2 1600 RP6R20A160
2
2000 RP6R20A200
Note
2 1 Includes B2016RDL rear connectors.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
100% Rated 600 Volts AC Digitrip OPTIM Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
2 Order as individual components: breaker frame (which includes trip unit) and rating plug.
2
100% Rated 600 Volts AC Digitrip OPTIM Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
2 Circuit Breaker Frame Only Digitrip OPTIM Rating Plug Only
2 L
S
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
2 Maximum
G
A
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response) Fixed
Continuous
2 Ampere LSIA 1050 LSIG 1050 Rating Plug
Rating Catalog Catalog Ampere Catalog
at 40 C Number Number Rating Number
2 Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
2 1200 ORPR16A120
1600 ORPR16A160
2 2000 1 CRD320T107W CRD320T106W 1000 ORPR20A100
1200 ORPR20A120
2 1600 ORPR20A160
2 2000 ORPR20A200
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
2
1600 ORPR16A160
2000 1 CRDC320T107W CRDC320T106W 1000 ORPR20A100
2 1200 ORPR20A120
1600 ORPR20A160
2 2000 ORPR20A200
2 Rating
at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
2
2
2
2
2
2000 Copper English B2016RDL
2500 Copper English B2500RD 3
Notes
1 Catalog Number includes bus connection, terminals and hardware for either line side or load side of three-pole breaker.
2
2 For use with 100% rated 1600 A and 2000 A frame. Do not order separately unless for replacement purposes. Included in breaker carton when
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Mounting Hardware
2
2 Breaker Line/Load
Conductors
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 TA2000RD
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Internal Accessories 1
Alarm lockout (Make/Break) V4-T2-276
Alarm lockout (2Make/2Break) V4-T2-276 2
Auxiliary switch (2A, 2B) V4-T2-276
Auxiliary switch (4A, 4B) V4-T2-276 2
2
Shunt tripstandard V4-T2-284
Shunt triplow energy V4-T2-285
Undervoltage release mechanism V4-T2-292 2
Accessory terminal block 2 V4-T2-293
External Accessories 2
Base mounting hardware V4-T2-313
Padlockable handle lock hasp V4-T2-316
2
Key interlock kit V4-T2-318 2
Walking beam interlock V4-T2-319
Electrical (motor) operator V4-T2-321 2
2
Handle mechanisms V4-T2-431
Handle extension 3 V4-T2-446
OPTIM System Components
2
Breaker interface module (BIM) V4-T2-327
Digitrip OPTIMizer V4-T2-327 2
Auxiliary power module V4-T2-327
Modifications (Refer to Eaton)
2
Special calibration
2
Moisture fungus treatment V4-T2-116
Freeze-tested circuit breakers 2
Marine/naval application
Legend
2
Applicable in indicated pole position
Accessory available/modification available
2
Notes
1 All accessories mount in the RH cavity which will accept one each shunt trip, UVR, auxiliary switch and alarm switch.
2
2
2 Mounts outside breaker.
3 Included with breaker.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 Circuit
Breaker Number
Interrupting Capacity (kA Symmetrical Amperes)
Volts AC (50/60 Hz)
2 Type
RD
of Poles
3, 4
240
125
277
480
65
600
50
2 CRD 2 3 125 65 50
RDC 3, 4 200 100 65
2 CRDC 2 3 200 100 65
2
IEC 947-2 Interrupting Capacity Ratings 1
2 RD
Icu 3, 4 135 70 25
2 Ics 3, 4 100 50 13
RDC
2 Icu 3, 4 200 100 35
2
Ics 3, 4 100 50 18
Notes
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
rms sensing Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Breaker Type
Frame R R R R R
2
Ampere range 8002500 A 8002500 A 8002500 A 8002500 A 8002500 A
Interrupting rating at 480 volts 65, 100 (kA) 65, 100 (kA) 65, 100 (kA) 65, 100 (kA) 65, 100 (kA) 2
Protection
Ordering options LI, LS, LSI, LIG, LI, LS, LSI, LIG, LI, LS, LSI, LIG, LI, LS, LSI, LIG, LSI(A), LISG 2
LSG, LSIG LSG, LSIG LSG, LSIG LSG, LSIG
Fixed rated plug (In) Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 2
Overtemperature trip Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Long Delay Protection (L)
2
Adjustable rating plug (In) No No No No No
2
Long delay pickup 0.51.0 x (In) 0.51.0 x (In) 0.51.0 x (In) 0.5 1.0 x (In) 0.41.0 x (In)
Long delay time I2t 224 seconds 224 seconds 224 seconds 224 seconds 224 seconds 2
Long delay time I4t No No No No 15 Seconds
Long delay thermal memory Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 2
High load alarm
Short Delay Protection (S)
No 0.85 x Ir 0.85 x Ir 0.85 x Ir 0.5-1.0 x Ir
2
Short delay pickup 200600%
S1 and S2 x (Ir)
200600%
S1 and S2 x (Ir)
200600%
S1 and S2 x (Ir)
200600%
S1 and S2 x (Ir)
150-800% x (Ir) 12 2
Short delay time I2t 100500 ms 100500 ms 100500 ms 100500 ms 100500 ms
2
Short delay time flat 100500 ms 100500 ms 100500 ms 100500 ms 100500 ms
Short delay time zone selective interlocking Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 2
Instantaneous Protection (I)
Instantaneous pickup 200600% 200600% 200600% 200600% 200800% x (In) 2 2
M1and M2 x (In) M1and M2 x (In) M1and M2 x (In) M1and M2 x (In)
Discriminator Yes 3 Yes 3 Yes 3 Yes 3 Yes 2
Instantaneous override Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Ground Fault Protection (G)
2
Ground fault alarm 4
4
No No No No 25100% x (In)
2
Ground fault pickup 25100% x (Is) 25-100% x (Is) 25100% x (Is) 25100% x (Is) 25100% x (In)
Ground fault delay I2t 100500 ms 100500 ms 100500 ms 100500 ms 100500 ms 2
Ground fault delay flat 100500 ms 100500 ms 100 500 ms 100500 ms 100500 ms
Ground fault zone selective interlocking Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 2
2
Ground fault thermal memory Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Legend
BIM = Breaker Interface Module
(A) = GF Alarm 2
Is = Sensor Rating
In = Rating Plug
Ir = Long Delay Pickup Setting x In 2
Notes
1 Except 2500 ampere frame is 200600%. 2
2 Varies by frame.
3 LS/LSG only. 2
4 Not to exceed 1200 amperes.
2
2
2
2 Digital display
Current
No
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes 1
Yes
2 Voltage No No No Yes No
Power and energy No No Yes Yes Yes
2 Power qualityharmonics No No No Yes Yes
Power factor No No Yes (over Yes Yes
2 Eaton PowerNet only)
Communications
2 Eaton PowerNet No No Yes Yes Yes
2
Testing
Testing method Integral Integral Integral Integral OPTIMizer, BIM,
PowerNet
2 Legend
2
Note
1 By OPTIMizer/BIM.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Note 2
1 No four-pole for CRD and CRDC.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Contents
2 Motor Circuit Protectors
Description Page
2 Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-116
Standards and Certifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-117
2 Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-118
V4-T2-121
2 F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-135
V4-T2-153
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-161
2 L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-185
M-Frame (300800 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-211
2 N-Frame (4001200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-222
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-237
2 Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP)
Catalog Number Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-257
2 Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-258
V4-T2-259
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB). . . . . . . . V4-T2-267
2 Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . . V4-T2-269
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-270
2 Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-273
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-306
2
2
2
2 Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP)
2 Product Description
Designated as Eatons Types
Standards and Certifications
The MCP is designed to
2 GMCP and HMCP, the
instantaneous-only motor
comply with the applicable
requirements of Underwriters
circuit protector (MCP) is Laboratories Standard UL
2 available in ratings from 3 A 489, Canadian Standards
to 1200 A for motor starter Association Standard C22.2
2 sizes 0 through 8. No. 5.1, and International
Electrotechnical Commission
An innovative design of
2 internal components allows
Recommendations
IEC 157-1.
higher MCP-starter
2 combination interrupting The MCP is a recognized
ratings. The MCP is marked component (UL File E7819)
2 to permit proper electrical
application within the
and complies with the
applicable requirements of
2 assigned equipment ratings. Underwriters Laboratories
Standard UL 489. It is also
designed to comply with the
2 applicable requirements of
Canadian Standards
2 Association Standard C22.2
No. 5.1, International
2 Electrotechnical Commission
Recommendations IEC 157-1,
and nameplates bear the CE
2 marking.
2
2
Note: Interrupting ratings are
2 dependent on starter it is used
with.
2
2
030 H1 = 90300/1 No Suffix: Standard terminals on line and load
050 G2 = 80120/2
K2 = 50500/2
070 J2 =
M2 =
115170/2
210700/2
2
100 L3 = 160240/3
150
R3 =
T4 =
3001000/3
4501500/4
2
2
U4 = 7502500/4
250 A5 = 350700/5
C5 = 450900/5
400 D5 =
F5 =
5001000/5
6251250/5 2
G5 = 7501500/5
J5 =
K5 =
8751750/5
10002000/5
2
2
L5 = 11252250/5
W5 = 12502500/5
N5 = 15003000/5
R5 =
X5 =
17503500/5
20004000/5 2
Y5 = 22504500/5
600 L6 =
X6 =
18006000/6 (electronic)
5002500/6 (electronic)
2
Y6 = 10004000/6 (electronic)
800 X7 = 16006400/7 (electronic) 2
1200 Y8 = 24009600/8 (electronic)
2
Motor Circuit Protector
2
GMCP 003 A0 C
2
Motor Circuit
Protective Device Continuous Magnetic Trip
Suffix
C = Non-aluminum terminals
2
Ampere Range/NEMA
2
GMCP = Three-pole
Rating Starter Size
003 A0 = 1530/0
007
015
C0 = 3570/0
E0 = 75150/0
2
030 H1 = 150300/1
050
060
K2 = 250500/2
J2 = 300600/2
2
2
063 M2 = 320630/2
Note
1 On J- and K-Frame HMCPs only. 2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
G-Frame
2
480 Vac Maximum, 600Y/347 Vac
2 NEMA Continuous Motor Full Load MCP MCP
Starter Size Amperes Cam Setting Current Amperes (FLA) 1 Trip Setting Catalog Number
2 0 3 A 1.11.2 15 GMCP003A0C
2
B 1.31.5 18
C 1.61.7 21
2 D 1.81.9 24
E 2.02.2 27
2 F 2.32.5 30
0 7 A 2.63.1 35 GMCP007C0C
2 B 3.23.6 42
2 C
D
3.73.9
4.34.7
49
56
2 E 4.85.2 63
F 5.35.7 70
2 0 15 A 5.76.8 75 GMCP015E0C
B 6.97.9 90
2 C 8.09.1 105
2 D
E
9.210.3
10.411.4
120
135
2 F 11.512.6 150
1 30 A 11.513.7 150 GMCP030H1C
2 B 13.816.0 180
2
C 16.118.3 210
D 18.420.6 240
2 E 20.722.9 270
F 23.025.2 300
2 2 50 A 19.322.9 250 GMCP050K2C
B 23.026.8 300
2 C 26.930.6 350
2 D
E
30.734.5
34.638.3
400
450
2 F 38.442.1 500
3 60 A 23.127.5 300 GMCP060J2C
2 B 27.732.2 360
C 32.336.7 420
2 D 36.941.4 480
2 E
F
41.546.0
46.250.5
540
600
2
E 43.648.9 570
F 48.553.7 630
2 Notes
1 Motor FLA ranges are typical. The corresponding trip setting is at 13 x the minimum FLA value shown. Where a 13 x setting is required for an intermediate FLA value, alternate Cam settings and/or
2
External Mounted Accessories
Description
Number Units
in Package
Style
Number
2
Lock dog (non-padlockable) 1 1294C01H01 2
Mounting hardware 1 624B375G23
DIN rail adapter 4 10 1225C79G02 2
Modifications for HMCP
See Internal Accessories starting on Page V4-T2-273.
2
Handle Mechanisms for Series C Frames 2
Kits Only (Kit Includes Shaft, Mechanism and Handle)GMCP-Frame 2
Rating Type GMCP-Frame
Catalog 2
Description NEMA IP Number
S01 Blue Handle S01 blue handle, 1/3R/12 54 GMHMVD12B / 68C6039G05 2
12-inch shaft 4/4X 65 GMHMVD12BX / 68C6039G07
2
S01 red handle, 1/3R/12 54 GMHMVD12R / 68C6039G06
2
S01 Red Handle
12-inch shaft 4/4X 65 GMHMVD12RX / 68C6039G08
2
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms
G Direct 5
2
Black Handle Yellow Handle 2
With Shroud Without Shroud With Shroud Without Shroud
Frame
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
GMCP HRGMC1S HRGMC10 HRGMC3S HRGMC30 2
Notes
1 Only one accessory may be installed in GMCP. 2
2 LH only.
3 RH only.
4 For use with standard 35 mm DIN rail such as, 35 x 7.5 or 15 mm per DIN EN50022.
2
2
5 Suitable for use on two- or three-pole G-Frame.
2
2
2
2
F-Frame
2
600 Vac Maximum, 250 Vdc Maximum 600 Vac Maximum, 250 Vdc Maximum, continued
2 Motor Motor
Full Load MCP Full Load MCP
2 NEMA
Starter Cont. Cam
Current
Amperes
Trip
Setting
MCP
Catalog
NEMA
Starter Cont. Cam
Current
Amperes
Trip
Setting
MCP
Catalog
2
Size Amps Setting (FLA) 1 2 Number Size Amps Setting (FLA) 1 2 Number
0 3 A 0.690.91 9 HMCP003A0C 2 70 A 16.121.4 210 HMCP070M2C
2 G
H
2.02.2
2.32.5
27
30
G
H
48.453.7
53.859.1
630
700
2
D 3.23.6 42 D 46.153.7 600
E 3.73.9 49 E 53.8 61.4 700
2 C
D
5.76.8
6.97.9
75
90
C
D
57.669.1
69.280.6
750
900
2 B
C
9.211.4
11.513.7
120
150
4 150 A
B
57.0 75.0
76.095.0
750
1000
HMCP150U4C
2
G 20.722.9 270 F 3 2000
H 23.025.2 300 G 3 2250
value shown. Where a 13 x setting is required for an intermediate FLA value, alternate Cam
D 23.026.8 300
2 E 26.930.6 350
settings and/or MCP ratings should be used.
2 For DC applications, actual trip levels are approximately 40% higher than values shown.
3 Settings above 130 amperes are for special applications. NEC Article 430.110(a) requires the
2 F
G
30.74.5
34.638.3
400
450
ampere rating of the disconnecting means to be not less than 115% of the motor full load
ampere rating.
2 H 38.442.1 500 HMCP 3100 A come with line and load steel body terminals, 3T100FB. HMCP 150A come with
line and load steel body terminals, 3T150FB.
2
2
2
MCPs for Application with Motor Starters Equipped with Electronic Overload Relays
2
600 Vac Maximum, 250 Vdc Maximum 600 Vac Maximum, 250 Vdc Maximum, continued
2 Motor Full MCP Motor Full MCP
NEMA Load Current Trip MCP NEMA Load Current Trip MCP
2 Starter
Size
Cont.
Amps
Cam
Setting
Amperes
(FLA) 1
Setting
2
Catalog
Number
Starter
Size
Cont.
Amps
Cam
Setting
Amperes
(FLA) 1
Setting
2
Catalog
Number
2
D 1.31.5 18 D 46.153.7 600
E 1.61.7 21 E 53.861.4 700
2 C
D
2.63.1
3.23.6
35
42
C
D
57.669.1
69.280.6
750
900
2 B
C
4.65.6
5.76.8
60
75
B
C
76.095.0
96.0114.0
1000
1250
2
G 10.411.4 135 G 3 2250
H 11.512.6 150 H 3 2500
2 C 11.513.7 150
value shown. Where a 13 x setting is required for an intermediate FLA value, alternate cam
settings and/or MCP ratings should be used.
D 13.816.0 180 2 For DC applications, actual trip levels are approximately 40% higher than values shown.
2 E 16.118.3 210
3 Settings above 130A are for special applications. NEC Article 430.110(a) requires the
ampere rating of the disconnecting means to be not less than 115% of the motor full load
2 F
G
18.420.6
20.722.9
240
270
ampere rating.
HMCP 25100 A come with line and load steel body terminals, 3T100FB.
2
HMCPS 3100 A come with line and load steel body terminals, 3T100FB. HMCPS 150A come
H 23.025.2 300 with line and load steel body terminals, 3T150FB.
2 50 A 11.515.2 150 HMCPS050K2C
2 B 15.319.1 200
C 19.222.9 250
2 D 23.026.8 300
2 E
F
26.930.6
30.734.5
350
400
2 G 34.638.3 450
H 38.442.1 500
2
2
2
2
value shown. Where a 13 times setting is required for an intermediate FLA value, alternate
C 72.079.2 935
cam settings and/or MCP ratings should be used.
D 79.386.5 1030 2 For DC applications, actual trip levels are approximately 40% higher than values shown.
3 Three-pole catalog numbers shown. Two-pole catalog numbers begin with HM2P in place
2
E 86.693.8 1125
2
of HMCP.
F 93.9101.1 1220 All HMCP and HM2P 250A come with line and load steel body terminals, T250KB. (With suffix
G 101.2108.4 1315 C, without C comes with TA250KB.)
H 108.5115.3 1410 2
I 115.4122.4 1500
2
K-Frame
2
600 Vac Maximum, 250 Vdc Maximum 600 Vac Maximum, 250 Vdc Maximum, continued
2 Motor Motor
Full Load MCP Full Load MCP
2 NEMA
Starter Cont. Cam
Current
Amperes
Trip
Setting
MCP
Catalog
NEMA
Starter Cont. Cam
Current
Amperes
Trip
Setting
MCP
Catalog
2
Size Amps Setting (FLA) 1 2 Number 3 Size Amps Setting (FLA) 1 2 Number 3
4 400 A 27.030.7 350 HMCP400A5C 5 400 A 77.086.5 1000 HMCP400K5C
2 G
H
47.050.7
50.853.8
610
660
G
H
134.7144.2
144.3153.8
1750
1875
2
C 48.153.0 626 C 108.5118.8 1410
D 53.157.6 690 D 118.9129.9 1545
2 5 400 A
B
48.153.8
53.959.9
625
700
HMCP400F5C 5 400 A
B
96.2108.0
108.1119.9
1250
1405
HMCP400W5C
2 H
I
90.096.1
96.2102.0
1170
1250
H
I
180.0192.3
192.4204.0
2340
2500
2
D 79.386.5 1030 D 158.5173.0 2060
E 86.693.8 1125 E 173.1187.6 2250
2
B 75.483.8 980 1 Motor FLA ranges are typical. The corresponding trip setting is at 13 x the minimum FLA
value shown. Where a 13 x setting is required for an intermediate FLA value, alternate cam
C 83.992.3 1090
settings and/or MCP ratings should be used.
2 D 92.4100.7 1200 2 For DC applications, actual trip levels are approximately 40% higher than values shown.
3 Three-pole catalog numbers shown. Two-pole catalog numbers begin with HM2P in place
E 100.8109.2 1310
2
of HMCP.
F 109.3117.6 1420 All HMCP and HM2P 400 A come with aluminum body terminals, 3TA400K. Catalog numbers
G 117.7126.1 1530 with suffix C as shown above come with copper body terminals 3T400K.
2 H 126.2134.6 1640
2 I 134.7142.8 1750
Motor Motor 2
Full Load MCP Full Load
NEMA
Starter Cont. Cam
Current
Amperes
Trip
Setting
MCP
Catalog
NEMA
Starter Cont. Cam
Current
Amperes
MCP
Trip
MCP
Catalog
2
(FLA) 1 Number 3 (FLA) 1
2
Size Amps Setting 2 Size Amps Setting Setting Number
5 400 A 134.7151.5 1750 HMCP400R5C 6 600 A 138.5184.5 1800 HMCP600L6W
B 151.6168.4 1970 B 184.6230.7 2400
2
C 168.5185.3 2190 C 230.8276.8 3000
D 185.4201.9 2410 D 276.9323.0 3600 2
E 202.0218.8 2625 E 323.1369.1 4200
F 218.9235.7 2845 F 369.2415.3 4800 2
G
H
235.8252.6
252.7269.2
3065
3285
G
H
415.4461.4
461.5507.7
5400
6000
2
I 269.3285.7 3500 6 600 A 38.546.1 500 HMCP600X6W 2
5 400 A 153.9173.0 2000 HMCP400X5C B 46.261.4 600
B 173.1192.3 2250 C 61.576.8 800 2
C 192.4211.5 2500 D 76.996.1 1000
D 211.6230.7 2750 E 96.2115.3 1250
2
E 230.8249.9 3000 F 115.4153.7 1500
2
F 250.0269.2 3250 G 153.8192.2 2000
G 269.3288.4 3500 H 192.3230.7 2500 2
H 288.5307.6 3750 6 600 A 76.996.1 1000 HMCP600Y6W
I 307.7326.9 4000 B 96.2115.3 1250 2
2
5 400 A 173.1194.5 2250 HMCP400Y5C C 115.4153.7 1500
B 194.6216.1 2530 D 153.8192.2 2000
C 216.2237.6 2810 E 192.3230.7 2500
2
D 237.7259.5 3090 F 230.8269.1 3000
E 259.6281.1 3375 G 269.2307.6 3500 2
F 281.2302.6 3655 H 307.7346.1 4000
G 302.7324.1 3935 Notes
2
H 324.2346.1 4215
2
1 Motor FLA ranges are typical. The corresponding trip setting is at 13 x the minimum FLA
value shown. Where a 13 x setting is required for an intermediate FLA value, alternate cam
I 346.2368.1 4500
settings and/or MCP ratings should be used.
2 For DC applications, actual trip levels are approximately 40% higher than values shown.
3 Three-pole catalog numbers shown. Two-pole catalog numbers begin with HM2P in place
2
of HMCP.
4 Equipped with electronic trip device. 2
All HMCP and HM2P 400 A come with aluminum body terminals, 3TA400K. Catalog numbers
with suffix C as shown above come with copper body terminals 3T400K. 2
All HMCP 600 A come without terminals. For terminals, see Page V4-T2-217.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
N-Frame
2
600 Vac Maximum 1
2 C
D
246.2307.6
307.7369.1
3200
4000
2 E 369.2430.7 4800
F 430.8492.2 5600
2 G 492.3553.7 6400
8 1200 A 184.6276.8 2400 HMCP12Y8W
2 B 276.9369.1 3600
2 C 369.2461.4 4800
D 461.5553.7 6000
2 E 553.8646.1 7200
F 646.2738.4 8400
2 G 738.5830.7 9600
2 Notes
1 Equipped with electronic trip device.
2
2 Motor FLA ranges are typical. The
Product Selection
2
2
FDMP and HFDMP
35 kA With Phase 65 kA With Phase
2
35 kA Without Phase Unbalance, Unbalance and Adjustable 65 kA Without Phase Unbalance, Unbalance and Adjustable
Continuous Amperes Class 10 Motor Protection Only Motor Class Protection Class 10 Motor Protection Only Motor Class Protection
2
80 FDMP3080L FDMP3080JL HFDMP3080L HFDMP3080JL
100 FDMP3100L FDMP3100JL HFDMP3100L HFDMP3100JL
2
2 Technical Data and Specifications
2 Specifications
Feature FDMP HFDMP
2 Interruption rating at 240 V 65 kA 100 kA
2
Interruption rating at 480 V 35 kA 65 kA
Interruption rating at 600 V 18 kA 25 kA
1
100 kA/50 kA 1
Icu/Ics at 415 V 35 kA/18 kA 65 kA/33 kA 1
2 100% rated No No
FLA range (A) 40205 40205
2 Motor class protection 5, 10, 15, 20 5, 10, 15, 20
2
Phase loss protection (current)active for phase current Min. phase 0.25 max. phase for 1 second Min. phase 0.25 max. phase for 1 second
>0.5 FLA setting
Thermal memory protection Yes Yes
2 High load indicator
2 Pre-detection relays
Internal accessories Factory installed Factory installed
2 Aux. alarm, shunt trip, UVR Aux. alarm, shunt trip, UVR
Notes
2 1 IEC ratings available only on FWMP and HFWMP.
Notes
2
1 Terminal wire connectors are UL listed for standard stranded wire sizes as defined in
UL 486A or UL 486B. 2
2 Optional on special order for copper cable only.
All HMCP 800 A and 1200 A come without terminals. For terminals, see Page V4-T2-217. 2
Contents
2 Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module
Description Page
2 Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-116
Standards and Certifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-117
2 Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-118
V4-T2-121
2 F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-135
V4-T2-153
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-161
2 L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-185
M-Frame (300800 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-211
2 N-Frame (4001200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-222
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-237
2 Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB). . . . . . . .
V4-T2-256
V4-T2-267
2 Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module
V4-T2-269
2 Product Overview
Power demand continues to
Product Description
The current limiting breaker
Features and Benefits
Superior system protection:
Standards and Certifications
UL 489
2 grow in new and existing
facilities. To meet increased
modules use a unique contact
design to enhance the
Auto reset improves
CSA C22.2
Thermal-Magnetic
2
40 FDC3040Q01 FDC3040YQ02
2
45 FDC3045Q01 FDC3045YQ02
50 FDC3050Q01 FDC3050YQ02 2
60 FDC3060Q01 FDC3060YQ02
70 FDC3070Q01 FDC3070YQ02 2
2
80 FDC3080Q01 FDC3080YQ02
90 FDC3090Q01 FDC3090YQ02
100 FDC3100Q01 FDC3100YQ02
2
110 FDC3110Q01 FDC3110YQ02
125 FDC3125Q01 FDC3125YQ02 2
150 FDC3150Q01 FDC3150YQ02
175 FDC3175Q01 FDC3175YQ02 2
200 FDC3200Q01 FDC3200YQ02
2
Limiter Terminals
2
Maximum
Breaker Amperes
Terminal
Body Material Wire Type
Metric Wire
Range mm2
AWG Wire Range/
Number of Conductors
Catalog
Number 2
Standard Pressure Type Terminals
2
250 Aluminum Cu/Al 10185 #8350 (1) TA250FJ 4
2
Breaker Load Terminals (For Line Mounted Limiters Only) 2
Package of
Maximum
Breaker Amperes
Terminal
Body Material Wire Type
AWG Wire
Range
Metric Wire
Range mm2
Three Terminals
Catalog Number
2
Standard Pressure Type Terminals 2
100 Steel Cu/AI 141/0 2.550 3T100FB
225 Aluminum Cu/AI 44/0 2595 3TA225FD 2
Notes
1 Line and load terminal included.
2
2
2 Two interphase barriers provided, mounted on line end of limiter, catalog number FJ1PBK.
3 Four interphase barriers provided, (2) line end of breaker, (2) load end of limiter.
4 Load side breaker terminations included for units configured with line mounted limiters.
2
2
2
2
2
2
Dimensions and Weights
2 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
2
FD-Frame With Current Limiter Module
2
2
2 4.12 4.13
2
(104.6) (104.9)
2
2
2
12.06
2 (306.3)
2
2 3.96
(100.5)
3.34
2 (84.8) 3.39
(86.1)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Auxiliary Switch
Shunt Trip
The shunt trip provides
operate from low energy
output signals from dedicated
in retaining slots in the
top of the trip unit. Coil is 2
intermittent-rated only.
The auxiliary switch provides
circuit breaker contact status
remote controlled tripping of
the circuit breaker. The shunt
current sensors typically
applied in ground fault Cutoff provisions required 2
information by monitoring the trip consists of an intermittent protection schemes. in control circuit.
position of the molded cross rated solenoid with a tripping However, with a proper 2
bar that contains the moving plunger and a cutoff switch control voltage source, they
contact arms. The auxiliary assembled to a plug-in may be applied in place of 2
switch is used for remote module. When required conventional trip devices for
indication and interlock
system verification, and
for ground fault protection
applications, certain AC rated
special applications. Flux
paths surrounding permanent
2
magnets used in the shunt
consists of one or two SPDT
switches housed in a plug-in
shunt trips, as noted in the
electrical rating table, are trip assembly hold a charged 2
module. Each SPDT switch suitable for operation at spring poised in readiness to
has one a and one b 55 percent of rated voltage. operate the circuit breaker 2
contact. When the circuit trip mechanism.
breaker contacts are open, 2
the a contact is open and
the b contact is closed. 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
J-Frame and HMCP (J) Alarm Switch
Factory Mounted Field Mounted 2
Connection Type and Location Field Installation Kits 9
Number of
18-Inch (457.2 mm) Pigtail Leads Terminal Block Pigtail Leads Terminal Block 2
Contacts Mounting Same Side Rear 7 Opposite Side Same Side
(Make and
Break)
Location
(Pole)
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
1 Left j B01 B02 B03 B04 A1L2LPK A1L2LTK 2
Right B05 B06 B07 B08 A1L2RPK A1L2RTK 6
Notes
2
2
1 F-Frame circuit breakers are factory sealed. Underwriters Laboratories requires that internal accessories be installed at the factory. Internal accessories are UL listed for
factory installation under E7819. Where local codes and standards permit and UL listing is not required, internal accessories can be field installed; however, this is not
recommended for FDE breakers. Accessory installation should be done before the circuit breaker is mounted and connected.
2 Includes 24-inch (609.6 mm) external pigtail leads,18 AWG (160.010).
3 A maximum of two internal accessories may be mounted in a three-pole circuit breaker.
2
2
4 Suitable for mounting in right pole only of two- or three-pole breaker.
5 Not listed with Underwriters Laboratories; for field installation.
6 Standard pigtail lead exit location.
7 Standard mounting location.
8 Factory installation only. Leads exit load end of circuit breaker.
2
2
9 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories; for field installation on interchangeable trip unit breakers under E64983.
j Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
2 2
Right 4
Left 3
B05
B09
B06
B10
B07
B08
B11
A1L3RPK
A2L3LPK
A1L3RTK
A2L3LTK
2 2 Left 3
Right
B09
B12
B10
B13
B11
B14
A2L4LPK
A2L4RPK
A2L4LTK
A2L4RTK
2
N-Frame and HMCP (N) Alarm Switch
2 Factory Mounted Field Mounted
Connection Type and Location Field Installation Kits 5
2 Number of
18-Inch (457.2 mm) Pigtail Leads Terminal Block Pigtail Leads Terminal Block
Sets of Mounting Same Side Rear 2 Opposite Side Same Side
2 Contacts
(1M and 1B)
Location
(Pole)
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
Right 3 B12 B13 B14 A2L5RPK A2L5RTK
2 Number of Contacts
(Make and Break)
Suffix
Number 6
Catalog
Number 6
2 1 B05 A1L6RPK
2 B12 A2L6RPK
2 Notes
1 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories; for field installation on interchangeable trip unit breakers under E64983.
2 4 Breakers with K-Frame OPTIM 550 can only accept accessories in left pole.
5 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation under E64983.
2
6 A maximum of three ASL plug-in modules may be installed in a circuit breaker.
2
2
2
Notes
2
2
1 Includes 24-inch external pigtail leads, 18 AWG (160.010).
2 A maximum of two internal accessories may be mounted in a three-pole circuit breaker. Suitable for mounting in right pole only of two- or three-pole breaker.
3 Standard pigtail lead exit location.
4 Not listed with Underwriters Laboratories; for field installation.
5 Pigtail wire size: 18 AWG (0.82 mm2).
2
2
6 Not for use on F-Frame with electronic trip unit.
7 125 volts (max.), 50/60 Hz switch for use in electronic circuit of 100 micro amperes and 15 Vdc minimum.
8 Not for use on four-pole circuit breakers.
9 Only for use on three-pole F-Frame breakers with electronic trip unit. Installation auxiliary switch for FD electronic breakers on right pole must be performed at 2
breaker factory.
j Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation or interchangeable trip unit breakers under E64983.
k Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
2
2
Right 2 A12 A13 A14 A2X4PK A2X4RTK 4
3 Left A18 A15 A3X4PK A3X4LTK
2
A and B (Pole) Number Number Number Number Number Number
1 Left A01 A02 A03 A04 A1X5PK A1X5LTK
2
1 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation under E64983.
2 Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
3 Breakers with K-Frame OPTIM 550 can only accept accessories in left pole.
2
6 This option is not field installable.
7 Available on the OPTIM 550 only. Communications are not available with this option.
b
Mounting
Location Suffix Suffix Suffix Catalog Catalog 2
(Pole) Number Number Number Number Number
Left 3 C01 C02 C03 AAL1LPK AAL1LTK 2
2
Right C04 C05 C06 AAL1RPK AAL1RTK 4
Number of
Connection Type and Location Field Installation Kits 5 2
18-Inch (457 mm) Pigtail Leads Terminal Block Pigtail Leads Terminal Block
2
Sets of
Contacts Mounting Same Side Rear 6 Opposite Side Same Side
(1A and 1B) Location Suffix Suffix Suffix Suffix Catalog Catalog
(1M1B) (Pole) Number Number Number Number Number Number
2
1 Left C01 C02 C03 AAL2LPK AAL2LTK
Right 4 C04 C05 C06 AAL2RPK AAL2RTK 4 2
K-Frame and HMCP (K) Auxiliary Switch and Alarm Switch Combination 2
Factory Mounted Field Mounted
Connection Type and Location Field Installation Kits 5 2
Number of 18-Inch (457 mm) Pigtail Leads Terminal Block Pigtail Leads Terminal Block
Sets of
Contacts Mounting Same Side Rear 6 Opposite Side Same Side 2
(1A and 1B) Location Suffix Suffix Suffix Suffix Catalog Catalog
(1M1B) (Pole) Number Number Number Number Number Number 2
1 Left C01 C02 C03 AAL3LPK AAL3LTK
Right 67 C04 C05 C06 AAL3RPK 8 AAL3RTK 2
2
Right C07 C08 1482D28G09 9j
Notes
1 Auxiliary switch and alarm switch combination options (Cxx) are not available on FDE 310+ with LSG or LSIG trip units due to exit wire limitations. To obtain both
features, order a left mounting alarm switch (B01-B04 or B09-B11), and right mounting auxiliary switch (A30-A32).
2
2 Not listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation.
3 Standard mounting location. 2
4 Not for use on four-pole circuit breakers
5 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation of interchangeable trip unit breakers under E64983.
6 Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
2
2
7 Breakers with K-Frame OPTIM 550 can only accept accessories in left pole.
8 Will not install on OPTIM Trip (RH).
9 Available on the OPTIM 550 only. Communications are not available with this option.
j This option is not field installable.
2
2
2
2
L-, HMCP (L) and (M) Frames and Auxiliary Switch and Alarm Switch Combination
2 Factory Mounted Field Mounted
2
1 Make/1 Break
Right 2 C10 C11 C13 AA214RPK AA214RTK 3
3A, 3B and Left C14 AA314LPK
2 1 Make/1 Break
Right 2 C15 AA314RPK
2 N-Frame and HMCP (N) Auxiliary Switch and Alarm Switch Combination
2
Factory Mounted Field Mounted
Connection Type and Location Field Installation Kits 1
2
18-Inch (457 mm) Pigtail Leads Terminal Block Pigtail Leads Terminal Block
Number of Mounting Same Side Rear 2 Opposite Side Same Side
Sets of Location Suffix Suffix Suffix Suffix Catalog Catalog
2 Contacts (Pole) Number Number Number Number Number Number
1A, 1B and Left C01 C02 C03 AA115LPK AA115LTK
2 1 Make/1 Break
Right 2 C04 C05 C06 AA115RPK AA115RTK 3
2 2A, 2B and
1 Make/1 Break
Left C07 C08 C12 AA215LPK AA215LTK
Right 2 C10 C11 C13 AA215RPK AA215RTK 3
2 Notes
1 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation under E64983.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
G-Frame circuit breakers are factory sealed. Underwriters Laboratories requires that internal accessories be installed at the factory. 2
Internal accessories are UL listed for factory installation under E7819.
Where local codes and standards permit and UL listing is not required, internal accessories can be field installed.
Accessory installation should be done before the circuit breaker is mounted and connected.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Same Side Rear 2 Opposite Side Same Side
Voltage Rating Suffix Suffix Suffix Suffix Catalog Catalog
(AC Frequency = 50/60 Hz) Number Number Number Number Number Number
2 Left-Pole Mounting AC/DC Ratings 2
2
Factory Mounted Field Mounted
Connection Type and Location Field Installation Kits 1
2
18-Inch (457.2 mm) Pigtail Leads Terminal Block Pigtail Leads Terminal Block
Same Side Rear 2 Opposite Side Same Side
Voltage Rating Suffix Suffix Suffix Suffix Catalog Catalog
2 (AC Frequency = 50/60 Hz) Number Number Number Number Number Number
Left-Pole Mounting AC/DC Ratings 2
2 1224 Vac or Vdc S41 S42 S43 S44 SNT3P04K SNT3T04K
2 380440 Vac or 220250 Vdc S13 S14 S15 S16 SNT3P14K SNT3T14K
480600 Vac S17 S18 S19 S20 SNT3P18K SNT3T18K
2 Right- or Neutral-Pole Mounting AC/DC Ratings 56
2
1224 Vac or Vdc S45 S46 S47 S48 SNT3P04K SNT3T04K 4
4860 Vac or Vdc S53 S54 S55 S56 SNT3P06K SNT3T06K 4
2 110240 Vac or 110125 Vdc 3 S29 S30 S31 S32 SNT3P11K SNT3T11K 4
380440 Vac or 220250 Vdc S33 S34 S35 S36 SNT3P14K SNT3T14K 4
2 480600 Vac S37 S38 S39 S40 SNT3P18K SNT3T18K 4
2
Notes
1 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation under E64983.
2 Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
2
2
2
2
2
2
Same Side Rear 2 Opposite Side Same Side Pigtail Leads Terminal Block
Voltage Rating Suffix Suffix Suffix Suffix Catalog Catalog
(AC Frequency = 50/60 Hz) Number Number Number Number Number Number
Left-Pole Mounting AC/DC Ratings 2 2
1224 Vac or Vdc
4860 Vac
S01
S05
S02
S06
S03
S07
S04
S08
SNT4LP03K
SNT4LP05K
SNT4LT03K
SNT4LT05K
2
4860 Vdc S85 S86 S87 SNT4LP23K SNT4LT23K 2
110240 Vac S09 S10 S11 S12 SNT4LP11K SNT4LT11K
110125 Vdc S41 S42 S43 S44 SNT4LP26K SNT4LT26K 2
380440 Vac or 220250 Vdc S13 S14 S15 S16 SNT4LP14K SNT4LT14K
480600 Vac S17 S18 S19 S20 SNT4LP18K SNT4LT18K
2
2
Right-Pole Mounting AC/DC Ratings 3
2
Same Side Rear 2 Opposite Side Same Side Pigtail Leads Terminal Block
Voltage Rating Suffix Suffix Suffix Suffix Catalog Catalog
(AC Frequency = 50/60 Hz) Number Number Number Number Number Number
2 Left-Pole Mounting AC/DC Ratings 2
2
480600 Vac S17 S18 S19 S20 SNT5LP18K SNT5LT18K
4860 Vdc S21 S22 S23 S24 SNT5LP23K SNT5LT23K
2
2 R-Frame Shunt Trip (RH Only)
Factory Mounted Field Mounted
2 Voltage Rating
(AC Frequency = 50/60 Hz)
Suffix
Number 4
Catalog
Number 4
2 24 Vac or Vdc
4860 Vac
S21
S25
SNT6P03K
SNT6P05K
2
4860 Vdc S88 SNT6P23K
110125 Vdc S45 SNT6P26K
2 Notes
1 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation under E64983.
2
4 A maximum of two shunt trip plug-in modules may be installed in a circuit breaker.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 UV
120 50/60 0.05 1373D62G03 T1
24 50/60 0.22 1373D62G04 T2
2 48 50/60 0.11 1373D62G05 T3
2
60 50/60 0.10 1373D62G06 T4
110 50 0.049 1373D62G07 T5
2 440
480
50
60
0.012
0.01
1373D62G13
1373D62G14
T11
T12
2 Notes
1 Includes 24-inch (609.6 mm) external pigtail leads, 18 AWG (160.010).
2 G-Frame circuit breakers are factory sealed. Underwriters Laboratories requires that internal accessories be installed at the factory.
Internal accessories are UL listed for factory installation under E7819.
2 Where local codes and standards permit and UL listing is not required, internal accessories can be field installed. Accessory installation
should be done before the circuit breaker is mounted and connected.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Voltage Rating Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
(AC Freq. = 50/60 Hz) Number Number Number Number
2
Left-Pole Mounting AC Ratings
12 Vac UVH1LP02K UVH1LT02K MUVH1LP02K MUVH1LT02K
2 380480 Vac
525600 Vac
UVH1LP15K
UVH1LP18K
UVH1LT15K
UVH1LT18K
MUVH1LP15K
MUVH1LP18K
MUVH1LT15K
MUVH1LT18K
2
12 Vdc UVH1LP20K UVH1LT20K MUVH1LP20K MUVH1LT20K
24 Vdc UVH1LP21K UVH1LT21K MUVH1LP21K MUVH1LT21K
2 12 Vdc
24 Vdc
UVH1RP20K
UVH1RP21K
UVH1RT20K
UVH1RT21K
MUVH1RP20K
MUVH1RP21K
MUVH1RT20K
MUVH1RT21K
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Terminal
18-Inch (457.2 mm) Pigtail Leads Block 1
Same Side Rear 2 Opposite Side Same Side Pigtail Leads Terminal Block 3 2
Voltage Rating Suffix Suffix Suffix Suffix Catalog Catalog
(AC Freq. = 50/60 Hz) Number Number Number Number Number Number 2
Left-Pole Mounting AC Ratings 4
12 Vac U05 U06 U07 U08 UVH2LP02K UVH2LT02K 2
2
24 Vac U09 U10 U11 U12 UVH2LP03K UVH2LT03K
4860 Vac U13 U14 U15 U16 UVH2LP05K UVH2LT05K
110127 Vac U17 U18 U19 U20 UVH2LP08K UVH2LT08K
2
208240 Vac U21 U22 U23 U24 UVH2LP11K UVH2LT11K
380480 Vac U25 U26 U27 U28 UVH2LP15K UVH2LT15K 2
Right-Pole Mounting AC Ratings 3
12 Vac U37 U38 U39 U40 UVH2RP02K UVH2RT02K 2
24 Vac
4860 Vac
U41
U45
U42
U46
U43
U47
U44
U48
UVH2RP03K
UVH2RP05K
UVH2RT03K
UVH2RT05K
2
110127 Vac U49 U50 U51 U52 UVH2RP08K UVH2RT08K 2
208240 Vac U53 U54 U55 U56 UVH2RP11K UVH2RT11K
380480 Vac U57 U58 U59 U60 UVH2RP15K UVH2RT15K 2
Left-Pole Mounting DC Ratings 4
2
24 Vac U09 U10 U11 U12 UVH3LP03K UVH3LT03K
4860 Vac U13 U14 U15 U16 UVH3LP05K UVH3LT05K
2 24 Vac
4860 Vac
U41
U45
U42
U46
U43
U47
U44
U48
UVH3RP03K
UVH3RP05K
UVH3RT03K
UVH3RT05K
2
12 Vdc T21 T22 T23 T24 UVH3RP20K UVH3RT20K
24 Vdc T25 T26 T27 T28 UVH3RP21K UVH3RT21K
2 Notes
1 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories, for field installation under E64983.
2 Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
2 5 Breakers with K-Frame OPTIM 550 can only accept accessories in left pole.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Terminal
18-Inch (457.2 mm) Pigtail Leads Block
Same Side Rear 2 Opposite Side Same Side Pigtail Leads Terminal Block 2
Voltage Rating Suffix Suffix Suffix Suffix Catalog Catalog
(AC Freq. = 50/60 Hz) Number Number Number Number Number Number 2
Left-Pole Mounting AC Ratings 2
12 Vac U05 U06 U07 U08 UVH4LP02K UVH4LT02K 2
2
24 Vac U09 U10 U11 U12 UVH4LP03K UVH4LT03K
4860 Vac U13 U14 U15 U16 UVH4LP05K UVH4LT05K
110127 Vac U17 U18 U19 U20 UVH4LP08K UVH4LT08K
2
208240 Vac U21 U22 U23 U24 UVH4LP11K UVH4LT11K
380480 Vac U25 U26 U27 U28 UVH4LP15K UVH4LT15K 2
Right-Pole Mounting AC Ratings 34
12 Vac U37 U38 U39 U40 UVH4RP02K UVH4RT02K 2
24 Vac
4860 Vac
U41
U45
U42
U46
U43
U47
U44
U48
UVH4RP03K
UVH4RP05K
UVH4RT03K
UVH4RT05K
2
110127 Vac U49 U50 U51 U52 UVH4RP08K UVH4RT08K 2
208240 Vac U53 U54 U55 U56 UVH4RP11K UVH4RT11K
380480 Vac U57 U58 U59 U60 UVH4RP15K UVH4RT15K 2
Left-Pole Mounting DC Ratings 2
2
Same Side Rear 2 Opposite Side Same Side Pigtail Leads Terminal Block
Voltage Rating Suffix Suffix Suffix Suffix Catalog Catalog
(AC Freq. = 50/60 Hz) Number Number Number Number Number Number
2 Left-Pole Mounting AC Ratings 2
2 12 Vac
24 Vac
U05
U09
U06
U10
U07
U11
U08
U12
UVH5LP02K
UVH5LP03K
UVH5LT02K
UVH5LT03K
2
12 Vdc T01 T02 T03 T04 UVH5LP20K UVH5LT20K
24 Vdc T05 T06 T07 T08 UVH5LP21K UVH5LT21K
2
R-Frame Undervoltage Release Mechanism (RH only)
2 Factory Mounted Field Mounted
Connection Type and Location Field Installation Kits 3
2 18-Inch (457.2 mm) Pigtail Leads Pigtail Leads
Voltage Rating Suffix Catalog
2 (AC Frequency = 50/60 Hz) Number 4 Number 4
12 Vac U37 UVH6RP02K
2 24 Vac U41 UVH6RP03K
2
4860 Vac U45 UVH6RP05K
110127 Vac U49 UVH6RP08K
2 110125 Vdc
220250 Vdc
T33
T37
UVH6RP26K
UVH6RP28K
2 Notes
1 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation under E64983.
2
4 Pigtail wire size: 18 AWG (0.82 mm2). Leads are orange and brown.
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 One 24-point accessory terminal block provided with circuit breaker when ordered factory installed or shipped
2
from warehouse as separate item when ordered for field installation. See Digitrip RMS master connection diagram
(IL 29C714). 2
2 Installation of these kits restrict any other attachments from being installed in the RH pole.
3 Includes a ground fault alarm signal that can drive the ground fault alarm unit (catalog number GFAU).
2
2
2
2
250 DC 0.25 3 2500 250 DC 0.25 4 2500
Single-Pole Circuit Breakers
2 Maximum
Voltage Frequency
Maximum
Current Amperes
Dielectric
Withstand Voltage
250 DC 0.25 4 2500
2
600 50/60 Hz 6 2500 1 Endurance: 6000 electrical operations plus 4000 mechanical operations.
2 Endurance: 6000 electrical operations plus 2000 mechanical operations.
125 DC 0.50 3 2500
3 Non-inductive load.
2
J-Frame Electrical Rating Data 25 N-Frame Electrical Rating Data 28
2
Maximum Maximum Dielectric Maximum Maximum Dielectric
Voltage Frequency Current Amperes Withstand Voltage Voltage Frequency Current Amperes Withstand Voltage
2
600 50/60 Hz 6 2500 600 50/60 Hz 6 2500
125 DC 0.50 3 2500 125 DC 0.50 3 2500 2
250 DC 0.25 3 2500 250 DC 0.25 3 2500
Notes
2
2
1 Endurance: 6000 electrical operations plus 4000 mechanical operations.
K-Frame Electrical Rating Data 27 2 Pigtail wire size: 18 AWG (0.82 mm2).
3 Non-inductive load.
Maximum Maximum Dielectric
Voltage Frequency Current Amperes Withstand Voltage 4 Endurance: 6000 electrical operations plus 2000 mechanical operations.
5 Endurance: 5000 electrical operations plus 1000 mechanical operations.
2
600 50/60 Hz 6 2500
125 DC 0.50 3 2500
6 Endurance: 3000 electrical operations plus 1000 mechanical operations.
2
250 DC 0.25 3 2500
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Shunt Trip
2 F-Frame and HMCP Shunt Trip Electrical Rating Data 123
2 Application Ratings
Voltage Frequency
Electrical Operating Ratings
Supply Voltage Minimum Operating Ip Irms at Irms at One Minute Dielectric
2
Catalog Number (V) (Hz) (V) Voltage (V) (A) 0.25 (A) 0.33s (A) VA Withstand Voltage (V)
SNT1LP03K or SNT1LT03K 1224 50/60 9 6.3 6.1 4.3 40 1048
2 12
24
8.5
17
6
12
75
300
2 1224 DC 12 9 8 100
24 16 400
2
240 1.4 0.29 240
380 2.3 0.31 610
2 110125 DC 110
120
77 0.5
0.55
55
66
2 415
440
1.1
1.2
0.8
0.85
330
380
2
1 Average unlatching time: 6 milliseconds.
2 Average circuit breaker contact total opening time: 18 milliseconds.
3 Endurance: 6000 electrical operations plus 4000 mechanical operations.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
K-Frame and HMCP (K) Shunt Trip Electrical Rating Data 323
2 Application Ratings Electrical Operating Ratings
2 Catalog Number
Voltage
(V)
Frequency
(Hz)
Supply Voltage Minimum Operating
(V) Voltage (V)
Ip
(A)
Irms at
0.25 (A)
Irms at
0.33s (A) VA
One Minute Dielectric
Withstand Voltage (V)
2 4860 DC
60
48 36
30.1
14.8
21.3 1280
710
2 60 18.4 1105
SNT3P11K or SNT3T11K 110240 50/60 110 60 1.3 0.9 100 1480
2 120 1.4 1 120
127 1.5 1.1 140
2 208 2.8 2 420
2
SNT3P14K or SNT3T14K 380440 50/60 380 285 0.37 0.25 95 1880
400 0.39 0.27 108
2 525
550
0.13
0.13
0.09
0.09
50
50
Notes
2 1 Approximate unlatching time: 6 milliseconds.
2 Approximate total circuit breaker contact opening time: 8 milliseconds.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
N-Frame and HMCP (N) Shunt Trip Electrical Rating Data 123
2 Application Ratings Electrical Operating Ratings
2 Catalog Number
Voltage
(V)
Frequency
(Hz)
Supply Voltage Minimum Operating
(V) Voltage (V)
Ip
(A)
Irms at
0.25 (A)
Irms at
0.33s (A) VA
One Minute Dielectric
Withstand Voltage (V)
2 60 3 2.1 126
SNT5LP11K or SNT5LT11K 110240 50/60 110 77 0.86 0.61 67 1480
2 120 0.98 0.69 83
127 1.1 0.75 95
2 208 2.3 1.6 333
2
440 0.35 0.25 110
220250 DC 220 154 0.21 46
2 250 0.22 55
SNT5LP18K or SNT5LT18K 480600 50/60 480 336 0.06 0.04 19 2200
2 525 0.08 0.06 32
550 0.08 0.06 33
2 600 0.1 0.07 42
2 Notes
1 Approximate unlatching time: 6 milliseconds.
2 Approximate total circuit breaker contact opening time: 18 milliseconds.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Dropout Voltage Pickup Voltage Dropout Voltage Pickup Voltage
Supply Supply
Voltage Minimum Maximum Maximum VA Voltage Minimum Maximum Maximum VA
2
48 21.0 33.6 40.8 1.2 48 21.0 33.6 40.8 1.3
60 21.0 33.6 40.8 1.9 60 21.0 33.6 40.8 2.0
2 110 44.5 77.0 93.5 1.3 110 44.5 77.0 93.5 1.5
120 44.5 77.0 93.5 1.5 120 44.5 77.0 93.5 1.7
2 127 44.5 77.0 93.5 1.7 125 44.5 77.0 93.5 1.9
208 84.0 145.6 176.8 2.2 220 87.5 154.0 187.0 2.6
2 220 84.0 145.6 176.8 2.4 250 87.5 154.0 187.0 3.4
2 240
380
84.0
168.0
145.6
266.0
176.8
323.0
2.9
2.9
2 48
60
21.0
21.0
33.6
33.6
40.8
40.8
2.5
3.8
48
60
21.0
21.0
33.6
33.6
40.8
40.8
2.0
3.1
2 110 44.5 77.0 93.5 1.8 110 44.5 77.0 93.5 1.6
120 44.5 77.0 93.5 2.1 120 44.5 77.0 93.5 1.9
2 127 44.5 77.0 93.5 2.4 125 44.5 77.0 93.5 2.2
208 84.0 145.6 176.8 2.7 220 87.5 154.0 187.0 3.1
2 220 84.0 145.6 176.8 3.1 250 87.5 154.0 187.0 4.0
2 Notes
1 Endurance: 6000 electrical operations plus 4000 mechanical operations.
2
2 Endurance: 6000 electrical operations plus 2000 mechanical operations.
3 For electrical rating data for manual, automatic and electrical reset undervoltage release mechanisms, refer to Eaton.
2
2
2
Supply
Dropout Voltage Pickup Voltage
Supply
Dropout Voltage Pickup Voltage 2
2
Voltage Minimum Maximum Maximum VA Voltage Minimum Maximum Maximum VA
12 4.2 8.4 10.2 1.9 12 4.2 8.4 10.2 1.6
24 8.4 16.8 20.4 3.9 24 8.4 16.8 20.4 3.1 2
48 21.0 33.6 40.8 2.5 48 21.0 33.6 40.8 2.0
60 21.0 33.6 40.8 3.8 60 21.0 33.6 40.8 3.1 2
110 44.5 77.0 93.5 1.8 110 44.5 77.0 93.5 1.6
120 44.5 77.0 93.5 2.1 120 44.5 77.0 93.5 1.9
2
127
208
44.5
84.0
77.0
145.6
93.5
176.8
2.4
2.7
125
220
44.5
87.5
77.0
154.0
93.5
187.0
2.2
3.1
2
220 84.0 145.6 176.8 3.1 250 87.5 154.0 187.0 4.0 2
240 84.0 145.6 176.8 3.8
380 168.0 266.0 323.0 3.4 2
2
415 168.0 266.0 323.0 4.0
440 168.0 266.0 323.0 4.6
480 168.0 266.0 323.0 5.4
2
Note
1 Endurance: 5000 electrical operations plus 1000 mechanical operations. 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 Supply
Voltage
Dropout Voltage
Minimum Maximum
Pickup Voltage
Maximum VA
Supply
Voltage
Dropout Voltage
Minimum Maximum
Pickup Voltage
Maximum VA
2 60
110
21.0
44.5
33.6
77.0
40.8
93.5
3.8
1.8
60
110
21.0
44.5
33.6
77.0
40.8
93.5
3.1
1.6
2 120 44.5 77.0 93.5 2.1 120 44.5 77.0 93.5 1.9
127 44.5 77.0 93.5 2.4 125 44.5 77.0 93.5 2.2
2 208 84.0 145.6 176.8 2.7 220 87.5 154.0 187.0 3.1
220 84.0 145.6 176.8 3.1 220 87.5 154.0 187.0
2 240 84.0 145.6 176.8 3.8 250 4.0
2 380
415
175.0
175.0
266.0
266.0
323.0
323.0
3.4
4.0
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes 2
1 Endurance: 500 electrical operations plus 2500 mechanical operations.
2 Pigtail wire size: 18 AWG (0.82 mm2). Leads are orange and brown. 2
3 UVR will override a momentary voltage dip up to the response time shown.
4 Unlatching occurs 1 millisecond before circuit breaker contacts begin to separate.
5 For 1 minute.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Contents
2 Series C External Accessories
Description Page
2 Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-116
Standards and Certifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-117
2 Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-118
V4-T2-121
2 F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-135
V4-T2-153
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-161
2 L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-185
M-Frame (300800 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-211
2 N-Frame (4001200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-222
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-237
2 Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB). . . . . . . .
V4-T2-256
V4-T2-267
2 Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-269
V4-T2-270
Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-273
2 External Accessories
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-310
2 Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-328
Technical Data and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-329
2 Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-330
2
2
2 External Accessories
2 Product Overview
End Cap Kit J-Frame Plug Nut Multiwire Connectors Rear Fed Terminals.
2 The end cap kit slides onto The plug nut is used in Eatons field-installed Rear fed terminals allow
the line or load conductor of applications where screw- multiwire connectors for the the cable to connect to the
2 the circuit breaker and acts as connected ring-type terminals load side (OFF) end terminals breaker from the back instead
a threaded adapter for the are preferred to connect are used to distribute the load of the top. Terminal shields or
2 conductor to accept a ring
terminal or other bolt-on
cables to circuit breaker
conductors. The plug nut is
from the circuit breaker to
multiple devices without the
interphase barriers are
included with each rear fed
2 connector. The end cap kit
is available with English and
press-fit into the opening in
the circuit breaker terminal
use of separate distribution
terminal blocks.
terminal kit (depending on
frame size). When catalog
metric thread sizes. (Field conductor. Screws and number starts with a 3, it
2 installation only.) Listed per washers are supplied by Multiwire lug kits include indicates a kit with three
UL File E7819. customer. mounting hardware, terminals in each kit. Catalog
2 insulators and tin-plated
aluminum connectors to
number beginning with a TA
Keeper Nut Terminal Adapter indicates one terminal.
2
replace three mechanical
The keeper nut slides onto
Control Wire Terminal Kit load lugs. UL listed as used
the line or load conductor of
on the load side (OFF) end.
2 the circuit breaker and acts as
a threaded adapter for the
The control wire terminal kit
provides a means to tap off
control power from a main Terminal Shields
conductor to accept a ring
2 terminal or other bolt-on disconnect, using the Terminal shields provide
connector. The keeper nut provided male end of a quick protection against accidental
2 is available with English and disconnect. contact with live line side
terminations. Terminal
metric thread sizes. Screws
For use with steel or stainless
2 and washers are supplied by
customer. (Field installation
steel terminals only.
shields are fabricated from
high dielectric insulating
material and fasten over
2 only.) Listed per UL File
E7819.
Note: Terminal Kits contain one
terminal for each pole and one the front terminal access
terminal cover. openings. Small openings in
2 L-, M-, N-Frames the shields provide limited
access to the terminals for
Not required. Terminals are
2 threaded.
tightening connectors.
(Field installation only.)
2
The electrical (motor) operator Panelboard Connecting Straps IQ Energy Sentinel Potential Transformer Module
2 allows the circuits breaker to Panelboard connecting straps The IQ Energy Sentinel The potential transformer
be opened, closed or reset are used to connect the is a highly accurate, module is required for the
2 remotely. It also has a lock-off circuit breaker terminals to microprocessor-based, Digitrip OPTIM 1050 to
capability and provisions for the panelboard bus. The breaker-mounted device provide a voltage input to
2 manual operation. panelboard connecting straps designed to monitor power allow the trip unit to monitor
The electrical (motor) are available with various and energy readings. It power and energy as well as
2 operator contains a reversible ratings for outside and center
poles. (Field installation only.)
represents an alternative to
watt meters, watt-hour
power factor. The potential
transformer module is a 6 VA
motor connected to a ball
2 screw. The ball screw drives
the circuit breaker handle.
Panelboard connecting straps
meters, and watt demand
meters. Key advantages
transformer with a primary
voltage input of up to 600 volt
are available to meet the include savings in space, line to line. Three 0.1 ampere
2 Limit switches and relays are
used to control the motor.
needs of most standard
panelboard applications.
lower installation costs, and fuses are provided on the
remote monitoring capability. primary of the transformer
2 Plug-In Adapters
Style numbers for mounting
brackets for CDP panelboard The IQ Energy Sentinel
and can be used for isolation
purposes during dielectric
Plug-in adapters simplify installations are also included. mounts on the load side
2 installation and front removal
Note: Not UL listed. Refer to
of a Series C F-Frame
testing. The device is
normally panel mounted
of circuit breakers. Individual (150 ampere) circuit breaker. and can feed up to 16 OPTIM
2 line and load plug-in
panelboard manufacturer for
compatibility. It can be applied on three- trip units.
adapters are available for phase, four-wire systems,
2 rear connection applications
on two-, three-, and four-pole
Type LFD Current Limiter or single-phase, three-wire
systems with voltage
Solid-State (Electronic) Portable
The LFD current limiter is an Test Kit
circuit breakers. Common
2 mounting plates for line-
accessory that bolts to the
load end of a standard FDB or
connected through
Phases A and C.
The solid-state (electronic)
portable test kit provides
and load-end adapters
2 are available.
FD thermal-magnetic circuit
breaker, providing 200,000 A
For more information, see
Descriptive Bulletin 8178.
verification of performance
of all ratings of Digitrip 310
interrupting capacity at up to electronic trip units installed
2 One plug-in adapter kit is
required for line-end and 600 Vac. LFD current limiters in circuit breakers while in
one for load-end. for thermal-magnetic and service under varying load
2 Plug-in adapters are
electronic circuit breakers and/or phase imbalance. The
are listed with Underwriters test kit operates on 120-volt,
2 UL approved unless
otherwise noted.
Laboratories under File
E47239.
50/60 Hz power; it includes
complete instructions and test
2 Rear Connecting Studs Ground Fault Alarm Unit
times for testing long time,
short time/instantaneous
Rear connecting studs are operation and optional
2
The ground fault alarm unit is
available in several sizes to a remotely mounted device ground fault operation of
accommodate specific fixed- with a combination indicating the circuit breaker.
2 mounted circuit breaker
applications.
light/test button that will light
when the breaker trips or
2 Each rear connecting stud alarms on ground fault. The
ground fault alarm unit
assembly consists of one stud
2 and one tube. To maintain requires a separate 120 Vac
power source to power the
proper clearances between
light and the internal relay,
2 poles, select alternate long
and short stud assemblies for which has 1NO and 1NC
contacts for remote indication.
2 circuit breakers with more
than one pole. One assembly The ground fault alarm unit
is required for line-end and can be panel mounted for
2 one for load-end of each pole. ordering with an optional face
mounting bracket. For use on
Tubes must be ordered
2 separately. Connecting studs
are available only with English
Digitrip 310 only, K- through N-
Frame.
2 thread sizes.
Note: Not UL listed.
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
Termination HardwareEnd Cap Kit
2
End Cap Kit
2
End Cap Kit
Thread Thread Catalog
Type Size Number
2 Two-Pole F-Frame (225A)
Imperial 1032 KPEK12
2 Metric M5 KPEKM12
2 Metric M5 KPEKM1
Four-Pole F-Frame (225A)
2 Imperial 1032 KPEK14
Metric M5 KPEKM14
2 Three-Pole J-Frame
Imperial 0.31218
2
KPEK2
Metric M8 KPEKM2
2 Four-Pole J-Frame
Imperial 0.31218 KPEK24
2 Metric M8 KPEKM24
Three-Pole K-Frame
2 Imperial 0.31218 KPEK3
Metric M8 KPEKM3
2 Four-Pole K-Frame
2
Imperial 0.31218 KPEK34
Metric M8 KPEKM34
2 Three-Pole L-Frame
Imperial 0.312-18 KPEK4
2
Metric M8 Line KPR3AM
Load KPR3BM
2 Note
L-, M-, N-Frames not required. Terminals are threaded.
2
2
J- and K-Frame Ordering Information
Terminals must be ordered separately. Priced individually. 2
J- and K-Frame Kit J- and K-Frame Control Wire Terminal Kit 2
Catalog
Description Number
2
Package of 12 control wire terminal tangs. KCWTK
2
2
2
L-Frame Control Wire Terminal Kit
AWG Wire Metric Wire Catalog
2
Range/Number Conductors Range mm2 Number
Al/Cu 95150 TA602LDCW 3
2
3/0350 kcmil (2)
Cu 120250 T602LDCW 3 2
250350 kcmil (2)
Al/Cu 185240 2TA603LDKCW 45 2
400500 kcmil (2)
Al/Cu 185240 3TA603LDKCW 46 2
400500 kcmil (2)
Al/Cu 185240 4TA603LDKCW 47 2
400500 kcmil (2)
Notes 2
1 K-Frame terminal adapter for use in replacing LB/DA breakers.
2 Not for use with T250KB terminals.
3 Individually packed.
2
2
4 Terminal kits contain one terminal for each pole and one terminal cover.
5 Two-pole kit.
6 Three-pole kit.
7 Four-pole kit. 2
Termination Hardware
2
G-Frame Control Wire Terminal
2 Catalog Catalog
Description Number Number
2 Control wire terminal (kit of 12) 5652B38G01 GCWTK
2
Multiwire Connectors Ordering Information (Package of 3)
2 Multiwire Connectors
Maximum Wires per Wire Size Kit Catalog
Amperes Terminal Range AWG Cu Number 1
2 G-Frame 2
2 J-Frame
250 3 142 3TA250J3K
2 6 146 3TA250J6K
K-Frame
2 400 3 142/0 3TA400K3K
6 143 3TA400K6K
2
2 Rear Fed Terminals
2 Frame
Maximum
Amperes
Wire Size
Range AWG Cu
Catalog
Number 1
2
FD 150 144/0 TA150FDRF
150 144/0 3TA150FDRF
2 Notes
1 When catalog number starts with a 3, it indicates a kit with three terminals in each kit.
2
2
Terminal Shields
2
G-Frame Terminal Shield
2 Catalog
Number Units in Package Number
2 10 GTSK3
2
F-Frame Terminal Shield
2 F-Frame
Standard (Package of 10) SpecialFor Use When Electrical
(Priced Individually) Operator is Mounted on Circuit Breaker
2 Number Catalog Catalog
of Poles Location Number Number
2 1 Line 625B229G06
2
2 Line 625B229G07
3 Line 625B229G08 4210B95G01
2
J-Frame J-Frame Terminal Shield
2 Number Catalog Number
of Poles Location (Package of 10)
2 2, 3 Line End 1266C07G01
2
4 Line End 6631C01G01
2, 3 Load End 6641C16G01
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Note
F-Frame Terminal End Covers
2
F-Frame 1 For use on three-pole breakers only.
Conductor Opening Catalog
Diameter in Inches (mm) Number
0.25 (6.35 mm) TEC1 2
2
0.41 (10.41 mm) TEC2
2
2
2
2
2 Handle Ties Snap-On Padlockable Handle Lock Hasp
2
2 10 HTBFD2P F PHL1
3 10 HTBFD3P
2 Number
of Poles
Number of Units
in Package
Catalog
Number
Notes
2 2
3
10
10
HTBGD2P
HTBGD3P
1 Accepts 0.285 Lock Shank.
2 Padlockable in the OFF position only.
2
Non-Padlockable Handle Block
2
Non-Padlockable Non-Padlockable Handle Block
2 Handle Block Catalog
Frame Number
2 F LKD1
J, K LKD3
2 L, M, N LKD4
2
2 Padlockable Handle
2 Padlockable G-Frame GD/GHC/GHB
Padlockable Handle
2 Number of Units
in Package
Catalog
Number 1
2 10 1223C77G03
10 1223C77G05 2
2 10 1223C77G06 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Cylinder Lock 2
Cylinder Lock Cylinder Lock 2
Catalog
Frame Number 2
F, J, K Order by description
2
2
Note
1 For padlockable handle lock hasp to padlock handle in OFF
2 F-Frame
Superior B-4003-1 0.38 (9.5) KYK1
2 Kirk F 0.38 (9.5) KYK1
Castell 1 K or QK 0.38 (9.5) CTK1
2 J, K-Frames
2
Kirk F 0.38 (9.5) KYK4
Castell 1 K or QK 0.38 (9.5) CTK4
2 R-Frame
Superior B-4003-1 1.0 (25.4) KYK6
2 Kirk F 1.0 (25.4) KYK6
Castell 1 K or QK 1.0 (25.4) CTK6
2 JG-Frame
2 Superior
Kirk
B-4003-1
F
0.38 (9.5)
0.38 (9.5)
KYKJG
KYKJG
2 Note
1 When ordering Castell Interlock, it is necessary for customer to specify that the mounting bolt holes must be
2 10 mm in diameter
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Frame
Centerline Spacing
in Inches (mm)
Catalog
Number
2
F 4.19 (106.4) SBK1 2
J 4.38 (111.3) SBK2
K 5.75 (146.0) SBK3 2
2
L, M 8.50 (215.9) SBK4
N 8.50 (215.9) SBK5
2
Walking Beam Interlock
Ordering Information 2
The walking beam interlock is With properly modified circuit
available for mounting
between two adjacent circuit
breakers, the walking beam
interlock is suitable for field
2
breakers spaced 1/4-inch (6.4
mm) apart and having the
installation. Order circuit
breakers specifying 2
same pole configuration. The modification for walking beam
two circuit breakers must be (20% price adder) and select 2
factory modified to accept the walking beam interlock from
walking beam interlock table below. Circuit breakers 2
assembly (suitable for use and walking beam interlock
with either two-, three- or
four-pole circuit breakers).
are boxed and shipped
separately.
2
Walking Beam Interlock
2
Walking Beam
Interlock
Frame
Catalog
Number
2
F WBL1
2
K WBL3
L, M WBL4A 2
N WBL5
R1 WBL6 2
Note
1 Three-pole only.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Electrical Operator
2
F-Frame Electrical (Solenoid) Operator
2 Terminal Block 18-Inch (457.2 mm) Pigtail Lead
2
Catalog Catalog
Voltage Frequency Number Number
2
120 AC EOP1T07 EOP1P07
240 AC EOP1T11 EOP1P11
2
F-Frame Electrical (Motor) Operator 1
2 18-Inch (457.2 mm) Pigtail Lead
Catalog
2 Voltage Frequency Number
120 50/60 Hz AC MOPFD120C
2 24 DC MOPFD24D
2 125 DC MOPFD120C
208240 50/60 Hz MOPFD240C
2 220250 DC MOPFD240C
2
Voltage Frequency Number
120 50/60 Hz AC EOP2T07
2
K-Frame Electrical (Solenoid) Operator
2 Terminal Block
Operating Catalog
2 Voltage Frequency Number
120 50/60 Hz AC EOP3MT07
2 240 50/60 Hz AC EOP3MT11
2
K-Frame Electrical (Solenoid) Operator Base Mounting Kit
2 Catalog
Frame Number
2 K BBMK3
2
2
L- and M-Frame Electrical (Motor) Operator (310 and OPTIM)
2 Terminal Block
Operating Catalog
2 Voltage Frequency Number
120 50/60 Hz EOP4MT07
2 208 50/60 Hz EOP4MT11
2
240 50/60 Hz EOP4MT11A
480 50/60 Hz EOP4MT15
2 125 DC EOP4MT26
24 DC EOP4MT21
2 Note
1 Motor operators MOP1P07, MOP1P03DC, MOP1P05DC and MOP1P07DC are replaced by MOPFD
2
2
2
2 Continuous Current
Rating (Amperes)
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
M-Frame (Flat Bar Type)600 Vac Maximum
2 Two-Pole Three-Pole
Continuous Current Catalog Catalog
2 Rating (Amperes) Number Number
800 2614D53G05 2614D53G06
2 Mounting plate 1290C73H01 1290C73H01
2
2 N-Frame (Flat Bar Type)
Two-Pole Three-Pole
2 Continuous Current
Rating (Amperes)
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2 FD 3 IEC PAD3F
FD 4 IEC PAD4F
2 JD 3 IEC PAD3JD
KD 3 IEC PAD3K
2 LD 3 IEC PAD3LD
2 LD 4 IEC PAD4LD
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
N-Frame Ordering Information 1
J-Frame 1 Stud Stud 2
Stud Stud Tube Ampere Catalog
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Rating Number
2
800 623B222G01
250A short 5010D23G01 456D983H05
800 623B222G02 2
250A short 5010D23G01 456D983H06
800 623B222G03
250A short 5010D23G01 456D983H07
1200 373B375G04 2
250A long 5010D23G02 5010D23H05
250A long 5010D23G02 5010D23H06
1200 373B375G03
2
Note
250A long 5010D23G02 5010D23H07 1 Not UL listed.
2
K-Frame 1 2
Stud
Ampere
Stud
Catalog
Standard Tube
Catalog 2
Rating Number Number
400 A short 6642C14G02 313C909H17 2
400 A short
400 A short
6642C14G04
6642C14G06
313C909H18
313C909H19
2
400 A long 6642C14G03 313C909H20 2
400 A long 6642C14G05 313C909H21
400 A long 6642C14G07 313C909H22 2
2
2
2
2
2 2.75 (69.9)
2.75 (69.9)
100
150
673B142G02
673B142G04
673B142G10
673B142G03
2
F-Frame Mounting Bracket
2 Catalog
Number of Poles Number
2 2 624B600H02
2
3 624B600H01
2 Bus Continuous
Pole Connector Type
Center Outside
Spacing Current
2 in Inches
(mm)
Rating
(Amperes)
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2 2, 3 208B264H01
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
M-Frame Mounting Bracket
Catalog
2
2
Number
315C270H01
2
N-Frame Panelboard Connecting Straps
2
Bus Continuous Pole Connector Type
Spacing
in Inches
Current
Rating Connector Catalog 2
(mm) (Amperes) Type Number
3.50 (88.9) 1200 Short 505C606G04 2
Medium
Long
505C606G05
505C606G06
2
2
N-Frame Mounting Bracket (Four Required)
2
Catalog
Number
2
315C270H01
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 1570 LFD3070R
Potential Transformer Potential Transformer Module
80160 LFD3150R Module
2 Description
Catalog
Number
2
The IQ Energy Sentinel The IQ Energy Sentinel
is a highly accurate, mounts on the load side of a
microprocessor-based, Series C F-Frame (150
2 breaker-mounted device ampere) circuit breaker. It can
designed to monitor power be applied on three-phase,
2 and energy readings. It
represents an alternative to
four-wire systems, or single-
phase, three-wire systems
2 watt meters, watt-hour
meters, and watt demand
with voltage connected
through Phases A and C.
meters. Key advantages
2 include savings in space, For more information, see
lower installation costs, and Descriptive Bulletin 8178.
2 remote monitoring capability.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Module (BIM) Catalog
Number Cause of Trip Display/Remote Mount Cause of Trip Display
The Cause of Trip Display can The DIGIVIEW version will
BIMII
be field-installed on any provide a local display at the 2
Digitrip RMS 310+ trip unit. breaker without additional
The device provides breaker
information through an LCD
wiring by connecting directly
onto the trip unit. The
2
Digitrip OPTIMizer
screen, such as cause of trip,
phrase current, ground
DIGIVIEWR06 version has a
6 foot cable that allows users 2
current and low loads. The to mount the display on the
The Digitrip OPTIMizer is a
hand-held programmer that is
the programmer, the eight-
pin connection cord, battery
display is ideal for outside of an enclosure door 2
troubleshooting common and connect to the trip unit
used to access, configure,
test and display information
and carrying case. The
auxiliary power module is
trips such as ground fault, that is contained inside the 2
long delay, and enclosure.
from OPTIM trip units. The optional.
OPTIMizer plugs into the
Note: 24 Vdc Power Supply
instantaneous/short delay. 2
front of an OPTIM trip unit via
2
A 24 Vdc power supply is Cause of Trip Display/Remote Mount
an eight-pin telephone jack required for all Digitrip OPTIM trip
and is powered by a nine-volt Cause of Trip Display
units that are required to
battery or the auxiliary power
module. One highlighted
communicate either on the main
Eaton PowerNet network or as a
Catalog
Number
2
2
feature is the Copy and subnetwork to a BIM. The DIGIVIEW
Download commands. breakers load is 45 mA of current.
Typically one power supply is DIGIVIEWR06
Setting up multiple OPTIM
trips can be finished in
required per switchboard and can
provide control power to a BIM
2
and the OPTIM trip units. The 24 Cause of Trip LED Module
minutes and with no errors.
An Auxiliary Power Module Vdc power supply should be an
The Cause of Trip LED breaker trips, the module 2
isolated high quality power
connection provides a trip test Module can be field-installed indicates the cause of trip
when control power is not
supply with a CE label, and is
normally provided by the on any Digitrip RMS 310+ trip (long delay, short delay, 2
present at the breaker. The switchboard manufacturer to unit. The device provides a instantaneous and ground) via
OPTIMizer is supplied as a Eatons recommendations. cause of trip indication via LED indication. The module is 2
standard package to include LED. The Cause of Trip LED reset after the breaker is
Module connects directly
onto the trip unit. When the
reset. 2
Digitrip OPTIMizer Digitrip OPTIMizer
Catalog
Number Cause of Trip LED Module
2
OPTIMizerstandard package Catalog
Number
2
TRIP-LED
2
2
2
2
Accessories
2
2 Flex Shaft Accessories (F- through R-Frame) Wire Seal
The wire seal can be used to secure the cover on the trip unit to
2 NEMA 12 Safety Door Hardware for Flex Shaft and C371 1 prevent adjustments after settings are confirmed.
Handle Length Catalog
2 in Inches (mm) Number 2 Wire Seal
4 (101.6) C361KJ4 Catalog
2 6 (152.4) C361KJ6
Description Number
2 As an option, an auxiliary switch is offered so that the control required for assembly.
2 The 1/4-inch x 1/2-inch (6.35 x 12.7 mm) standard mill rectangular locking bar is not supplied
panel builder may electrically indicate the status of the breaker.
2 This accessory would be mounted on the mechanism and
with these kits.
3 Third roller latch for use with 4- or 6-inch (101.6 or 152.4 mm) handle when 3 point latching is
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Voltage 3 Frequency
Inrush Current
Amperes 2
120
24
AC
DC
2
5
N-Frame Electrical (Motor) Operator Rating Data 16kl 2
Operating Inrush Current Fuse
48 DC 3 Voltage 3 Frequency Amperes Amperes 2
125 DC 2 120 50/60 Hz 31 6
208 50/60 Hz 21 2
2
240 50/60 Hz 19 4
J-Frame Electrical (Solenoid) Operator Rating Data 1689
480 50/60 Hz
Inrush Current Fuse
Voltage 3 Amperes Amperes 24 DC 50
2
120 30 6 48 DC 80
240 16 4 125 DC 21 2
2
K-Frame Electrical (Solenoid) Operator Rating Data 1689 R-Frame Electrical (Motor) Operator Rating Data mnop
Operating Inrush Current Fuse Operating Motor Inrush Current 2
Voltage 3 Amperes Amperes Voltage q Frequency Amperes
duty cycle (OFF to ON to OFF) should not exceed one per minute.
8 The electrical operator design has been endurance tested for 6000 electrical operations.
2
2
9 Maximum operating time: 5 cycles (80 mS).
j Maximum operating time: 12 cycles.
k The electrical operator design has been endurance tested for 2,500 electrical operations.
l Maximum operating time: 12 cycles max. Operator is an intermittent duty device. The safe
duty cycle (OFF to ON to OFF) should not exceed one per minute.
2
2
m Operator is an intermittent duty service. The safe duty cycle (OFF to ON to OFF) should not
Dimensions
2 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
2 F-Frame 1
Stud Stud Panel Thickness Tube Length Tube Dimensions
2 Ampere Catalog Catalog
Rating Number A B C Number D E F
2 100 A short
100 A short
451D874G01
451D874G01
0.380.63 (9.5 to 15.9)
0.250.31 (6.4 to 7.9)
1.69 (42.9)
2.00 (50.8)
32B9446H22
32B9446H23
3.63 (92.1)
3.63 (92.1)
0.31 (7.9)18
0.31 (7.9)18
2 100 A long 451D874G02 1.00 (25.4) 3.44 (87.3) 32B9446H24 6.13 (155.6) 0.31 (7.9)18
100 A long 451D874G02 0.690.94 (17.5 to 23.8) 3.75 (95.2) 32B9446H25 6.13 (155.6) 0.31 (7.9)18
2 100 A long 451D874G02 0.380.63 (9.5 to 15.9) 4.06 (103.1) 32B9446H26 6.13 (155.6) 0.31 (7.9)18
100 A long 451D874G02 0.250.31 (6.4 to 7.9) 4.38 (111.3) 32B9446H27 6.13 (155.6) 0.31 (7.9)18
2 For 110 to 225 Ampere Circuit Breakers
2 225A short
225A short
374D883G01
374D883G01
1.00 (25.4)
0.690.94 (17.5 to 23.8)
1.06 (26.9)
1.38 (34.9)
374D883H06
374D883H07
4.25 (108.0)
4.25 (108.0)
0.44 (11.1)14
0.44 (11.1)14
2 225A short 374D883G01 0.380.63 (9.5 to 15.9) 1.69 (42.9) 374D883H08 4.25 (108.0) 0.44 (11.1)14
225A short 374D883G01 0.250.31 (6.4 to 7.9) 2.00 (50.8) 374D883H09 4.25 (108.0) 0.44 (11.1)14
2 225A long 374D883G02 1.00 (25.4) 3.44 (87.3) 374D883H10 7.50 (190.5) 0.44 (11.1)14
2
225A long 374D883G02 0.690.94 (17.5 to 23.8) 3.75 (95.2) 374D883H11 7.50 (190.5) 0.44 (11.1)14
225A long 374D883G02 0.380.63 (9.5 to 15.9) 4.06 (103.1) 374D883H12 7.50 (190.5) 0.44 (11.1)14
2 225A long 374D883G02 0.250.31 (6.4 to 7.9) 4.38 (111.3) 374D883H13 7.50 (190.5) 0.44 (11.1)14
2 F-Frame
2 B
E
2 Mounting Panel
2 F Thread
Breaker Mounting
2 Surface
2 .06
(1.5) A C
.75
2
D
(19.1)
2
Note
1 Not UL listed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Breaker
2
Mounting Panel
B 2
3.63
(92.2)
2
2
K-Frame 1
Stud Stud Panel Thickness Tube Length Standard Tube Dimensions 2
Ampere Catalog Catalog
Rating Number A B C Number D E F 2
400 A short 6642C14G02 0.751 (19.125.4) 0.84 (21.3) 313C909H17 3.66 (93.0) 0.7516 (19.1406.4)
400 A short 6642C14G04 0.500.75 (12.718.4) 1.09 (27.69) 313C909H18 2
2
400 A short 6642C14G06 0.250.5 (6.3512.7) 1.03 (26.16) 313C909H19
400 A long 6642C14G03 0.751 (19.125.4) 3.78 (96.0) 313C909H20
400 A long 6642C14G05 0.500.75 (12.718.4) 4.03 (102.4) 313C909H21 6.58 (167.1)
2
400 A long 6642C14G07 0.25 0.5 (6.3512.7) 4.28 (108.7) 313C909H22
2
E 2
B
Mounting Panel
2
F Thread 2
Breaker Mounting
Surface 2
2
0.06 A C
(1.5)
1.67
2
D
(42.4)
2
Note
1 Not UL listed. 2
2 Insulators
Washer
2 Nut
2
2 Circuit Breaker Rear
Connecting
2 Insulating Panel
Stud
2
M-Frame
2 Stud Diameter Extension Stud
Ampere and Back of Catalog
2 Rating Thread Breaker Number
225 0.50 (12.7)13 3.66 (93.0) 314C960G01
2 400 0.75 (19.1)16 5.91 (150.1) 314C960G04
2 400
400
0.75 (19.1)16
0.75 (19.1)16
8.41 (213.6)
10.91 (277.0)
314C960G05
314C960G06
2 N-Frame
2 Stud
Ampere
Diameter
and
Extension
Back of
Stud
Catalog
Rating Thread Breaker Number
2 800 1.13 (28.7)12 5.5 (139.7) 623B222G01
2
Definite Purpose Molded Case Circuit Breakers 2
Optimized solution for HVAC/R and Pumping Applications.
2
Product Overview
2
GP, FP, KP, LP and MP Frames Eatons Definite Purpose Trip Units and Terminals External Accessories
15800 Amperes
NEMA 480 Vac
breakers are rated from 15
800 A and are available in five
Definite Purpose breakers Definite Purpose breakers 2
contain factory-sealed use the same external
Eatons Definite Purpose
molded case circuit breakers
frame sizes. Each frame size
has the same compact
thermal-magnetic trip units. accessories as Series C
breakers: handle
2
are available in three-pole outside dimensions as The GP-Frame breaker
configurations, and are Series C breakers. (15100 A) includes line and
mechanisms, motor
operators, lock-off devices, 2
designed to meet the specific load terminals and breaker busbar extensions and
requirements of HVAC/R Additionally, Definite Purpose
breakers have been
mounting hardware. multiple terminal 2
and pumping applications. arrangements.
rigorously tested to the FP (15225A), KP (200
As with other members of UL 489 standard. They 400 A), LP (450600 A) and 2
Eatons family of molded are assembled in an ISO MP (700800 A) Frames ship
case circuit breakers, Definite certified facility. standard without mounting
hardware. For line and load
2
Purpose breakers provide
high quality, reliability,
unmatched performance
terminals, add L to the end
of the catalog number or W 2
for no terminals.
and outstanding value.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 Breaker Type GPS FPS FPH KPS KPH
Amperage range 15100 A 15225A 15225A 200400 A 200400 A
2 Performance level S S H S H
Breaker capacity (kA rms) 240 Vac 65 65 100 65 100
2 NEMA, UL, CSA 480 Vac 22 35 65 35 65
2
600 Vac 18 25 25 35
Number of poles 3 3 3 3 3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Features
2
Base Mounting Hardware Base Mounting Hardware
2 English base mounting Catalog Number
hardware is included with
2
Frame English Metric
GP frame only. For all other
GP Included
frames, order base mounting
2 hardware separately as per
the table to the right.
FP
KP
BMH1
BMH3
BMH1M
BMH3M
2 LP
MP
BMH4
BMH5
BMH4M
BMH5M
2 100
100
#8
#6#4
Cu/Al
Cu/Al
3T100FB 1
3T100FB 1
2 100
200
#34/0
#34/0
Cu/Al
Cu only
3T100FB 1
3T150FB 1
Ampere Rating 2
GP-Frame FP-Frame KP-Frame LP-Frame MP-Frame
015 = 15A
020 = 20 A
015 = 15A
020 = 20 A
175 = 175A
200 = 200 A
450 = 450 A
500 = 500 A
700 = 700 A
800 = 800 A
2
025 = 25 A 025 = 25 A 250 = 250 A 600 = 600 A
030 = 30 A
035 = 35A
030 = 30 A
035 = 35A
300 = 300 A
400 = 400 A
2
2
040 = 40 A 040 = 40 A
045 = 45A 045 = 45A
050 = 50 A 050 = 50 A
060 = 60 A
070 = 70 A
060 = 60 A
070 = 70 A 2
080 = 80 A 080 = 80 A
090 = 80 A
100 = 100 A
100 = 100 A
110 = 110 A
2
2
125 = 125A
150 = 150 A
175 = 175A
200 = 200 A
225 = 225A 2
Notes
1 Not available on GP-Frame.
2
2 When choosing a molded case switch, select the highest amperage rating for the frame and the standard interrupting rating.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
Catalog Numbers
2 When ordering Definite Purpose breakers, use the appropriate
catalog numbers given below.
2
2 GP 100 GP-Frame/15100 A FP 225 FP-Frame/15225 A
Three-Pole Three-Pole
2 Frame/ Catalog Frame/ Catalog
Ampere Rating Number Ampere Rating Number
2 GP/15100 A circuit breakers GPS3015 FP/15225A circuit breakers FPS3015
GPS3020 FPS3020
2 GPS3025 FPS3025
2 GPS3030 FPS3030
GPS3035 FPS3035
2 GPS3040 FPS3040
GPS3045 FPS3045
2 GPS3050 FPS3050
2
GPS3060 FPS3060
GPS3070 FPS3070
2 GPS3080 FPS3080
GPS3090 FPS3090
2 GPS3100 FPS3100
GP/100 A molded case switch GPS3100K FPS3110
2 Note: All GP frames come standard with line and load terminals FPS3125
and base mounting hardware. Not available without terminals.
2 FPS3150
FPS3175
2 FPS3200
FPS3225
2 FPH3015
FPH3020
2 FPH3025
2 FPH3030
FPH3035
2 FPH3040
FPH3045
2 FPH3050
2
FPH3060
FPH3070
2 FPH3080
FPH3090
2 FPH3100
FPH3110
2 FPH3125
2 FPH3150
FPH3175
2 FPH3200
FPH3225
2 FP/225A molded case switch FPS3225K
Contents
2 PM3 Modules
Description Page
2 PM3 Monitoring and Metering Module
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-341
2 Technical Data and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-341
Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-342
2
2 Learn
Online
Drawings
Online
2
2
2
2
Power Monitoring and Metering with Modbus RTU
2
2 PM3 Monitoring and Metering Module
2 Product Description Application Description Features and Benefits Standards and Certifications
The PM3 is the perfect Communications via Communicates electrical Meets ANSI C12.1
2 solution for main, branch Modbus and Eatons system data and circuit revenue grade standard
circuit and standalone INCOM protocol; breaker status with a current and
2 monitoring/metering
applications. With information
compatible with Eatons
PXG for Web page and
Calculates power and voltage accuracy of
0.5% of reading
energy to an accuracy of
2 at your fingertips, you can
meter, monitor and
Ethernet capabilities
Works in 240 Vac PM3,
1.0% of reading
Configurable with thermal-
UL 489, Annex J
IEC 61000-4-2ESD
communicate phase current 480 Vac and 600 Vac
2 and voltage with calculated applications
magnetic or electronic
trip units
IEC 61000-4-4EFT
power and energy. IEC 61000-4-5SURGE
480 Vac PM3 has
2 Suitable for reverse-feed
monitoring to 1.0%
of reading
2 Reduces cost of ownership
2
2
LG
for K-Frame
Metric end cap kit L3RTWK Accuracy 1% of reading (ANSI C12.1) 2
2
for LG-Frame Isolation
All inputs and outputs are galvanically isolated to 2500 V.
2 1.38
3.50 (88.9)
3.39
3.57 (90.7)
3.44
(86.1) 1.38 (87.4)
(35.1)
2 0.69
(17.5) Line End
3.19
(81.0)
(35.1)
0.69
(17.5) Line End
3.34
(84.8)
2
123456789101112131415
3.63 3.63
2.88 On
(92.2) (92.2) 3.95 3.95
Off 3.17 (100.3)
2
(73.2) (100.3)
6.00 (80.5) 7.00
4.50 (152.4) O
N
(177.8)
CL CL
(114.3) Handle Handle CL CL
2
O
F
LED F
Handle Handle
RY EA
S
FACTO
5.50 PUSH TO
TRIP
(139.7) LED
RY EA
S
2
FACTO
O
N 1 2 3 4 5 6
11.00
2
9.53
(279.4) 10.50 12.00
(242.1) O
1 2 3 4 5 6
(266.7)
N
(304.8)
2 123456789101112131415
2 2.06
(52.3) Load End
3.34
(84.8)
123456789101112131415
2 4.41 (112.0)
2
4.06 4.06
1.72 1.72
(103.1) (103.1)
(43.7) 0.86 (43.7)
3.81 0.86 3.98
(21.8) Line End Line End
2
(96.8) (21.8) (101.1)
2 4.92 5.77
(146.6) 5.77 4.73 5.58
5.58
(125.0) (120.1) (141.7)
(146.6) (141.7)
2 On/I
CL CL CL CL
2 8.44
(214.4)
Off/O Handle Handle
8.44
(214.4)
Handle Handle
10.13 10.13
2
(257.3) (257.3)
2 12.14
(308.4)
Power Monitoring/
Metering Module
ON O
N1
Tx
Settings
1 2 3 4 5 6
2 3 4 5 6
Rx STATUS
Network Address
13.83
12.14
(308.4)
Power Monitoring/
Metering Module Tx
Settings
Rx
1 2 3 4 5 6
STATUS
(351.0)
COM
B MODBUS
COM
COM
Aux. Alarm Bell Alarm
2
EARTH A
V Neutral COM
24 Vdc (+) See breaker for terminal information. B MODBUS
Power See instruction sheet for high voltage tests. COM
24 Vdc () COM
For use on Series G, L-Frame or Series C, K-Frame Aux. Alarm
Circuit Breaker, Switch, Motor Circuit Protector. EARTH
V Neutral
24 Vdc (+) See breaker for terminal information.
Power See instruction sheet for high voltage tests.
24 Vdc ()
For use on Series G, L-Frame or Series C, K-Frame
Circuit Breaker, Switch, Motor Circuit Protector.
2.74 3.98
2 (69.6)
5.48 (139.2)
Load End
4.06
(101.1) 2.74
(69.6)
Load End
3.98
(101.1)
5.48 (139.2) 4.06
2
(103.1)
(103.1)
4.88 (124.0)
5.43 (137.9)
2 Description
Weight in lbs (kg)
Frame
FD
Dimensions and Weights
1.26 (0.57)
2 JG
KD/LG
1.60 (0.73)
2.25 (1.02)
2 Basic unit in inches (mm) FD 4.13 W x 5.00 L x 3.39 H (104.9 x 127.0 x 86.1)
JG 4.13 W x 5.00 L x 3.39 H (104.9 x 127.0 x 86.1)
FG 3 100 W
2
2 Frame
FG Number of Poles Trip Amperes
Suffix
W = Without terminals
2 3 = Three-pole 015
020
025
2 030
035
040
2 045
050
2
060
070
080
2 090
100
125
2 150
175
2
200
225
JG
2 175
200
225
2 KG
250
300
2 350
400
2
LG
450
500
2 NG
600
700
2 800
900
2 1000
1200
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Fixed 14 12 29 23 36 29 FG3040 4
Fixed 16 13 32 26 41 32 FG3045 4 2
Fixed 18 14 36 29 45 36 FG3050 4
Fixed 22 17 43 35 54 43 FG3060 4 2
Fixed 25 20 51 40 63 51 FG3070 4
Fixed 29 23 58 46 72 58 FG3080 4
2
2
Fixed 32 26 65 52 81 65 FG3090 4
Fixed 36 29 72 58 90 72 FG3100 4
Fixed 40 32 79 64 99 79 FG3110 4 2
Fixed 45 36 90 72 113 90 FG3125 4
Fixed 54 43 108 87 135 108 FG3150 4 2
FG3175 4
2
Fixed 63 51 126 101 158 126
Fixed 72 58 144 116 181 144 FG3200 4
Fixed 81 65 162 130 203 162 FG3225 4
2
350700 63 51 126 101 158 126 JG3175W 5
350700 63 51 126 101 158 126 JG3175 4 2
350700 72 58 144 116 181 144 JG3200W 5
350700 72 58 144 116 181 144 JG3200 4 2
350700
350700
81
81
65
65
162
162
130
130
203
203
162
162
JG3225W 5
JG3225 4
2
350700 90 72 181 144 226 181 JG3250W 5 2
350700 90 72 181 144 226 181 JG3250 4
5001000 108 87 217 173 271 217 KG3300W 5 2
5001000 108 87 217 173 271 217 KG3300 4
5001000 126 101 253 202 316 253 KG3350W 5 2
5001000
10002000
126
144
101
116
253
289
202
231
316
361
253
289
KG3350 4
KG3400 4
2
Notes 2
1 Breaker continuous current is based on 115% of the generator full load ampere rating.
2 Based on three-phase generators at 80% power factor.
3 FG, JG, KG include thermal-magnetic trip units, LG and NG include electronic trip units.
2
2
4 Breaker includes line and load terminals.
5 Without terminals.
2
The following catalog numbers have center tap studs for dual voltage applications: JG3070CT, JG3100CT, JG3125CT, KG3175CT, LG3300CTW.
Electronic
2 Engine Generator
Maximum Generator Rating 60 Hz Breaker 3
2 Magnetic 240 Vac 480 Vac 600 Vac Catalog
Pickup Range kVA 1 kW 2 kVA 1 kW 2 kVA 1 kW 2 Number
2 5002500 162 130 325 260 406 325 LG3450 4
2
12505000 361 289 722 578 903 722 NG31000 4
12505000 433 347 867 693 1083 867 NG31200 4
2 Notes
1 Breaker continuous current is based on 115% of the generator full load ampere rating.
2 The following catalog numbers have center tap studs for dual voltage applications: JG3070CT, JG3100CT, JG3125CT, KG3175CT, LG3300CTW.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Dimensions and Weights
2 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
2
Breaker
Frame Enclosure Approx. Weight Conduit Sizes, Catalog
Amperes Type Class A B C D E Lbs (kg) Inches Number
2 FG Type 1 23.25 (590.6) 8.41 (213.6) 6.28 (159.5) 18.75 (476.3) 1.20 (30.5) 15 (7) 0.25, 0.50, 0.75, 1, 1.25, 1.50, 2, 2.50 SFDN225
15225
Type 3R 25.66 (651.8) 8.84 (224.7) 9.31 (236.5) 24.28 (616.7) 1.70 (43.2) 19 (9) 0.25, 0.50, 0.75, 1, 1.25, 1.50, 2, 2.50 RFDN225
2 Type 12 25.66 (651.8) 8.84 (224.7) 9.31 (236.5) 24.28 (616.7) 1.70 (43.2) 18 (8) JFDN225
2 JG
175250
Type 1
Type 3R
34.70 (881.4)
37.50 (952.5)
10.92 (277.4)
11.56 (293.6)
7.20 (182.9)
10.22 (259.6)
30.00 (762.0)
35.77 (908.6)
1.88 (47.8)
1.94 (49.3)
31 (14)
40 (18)
0.25, 0.50, 2, 2.50, 3
0.25, 0.50, 2, 2.50, 3
SJDN250
RJDN250
2 Type 12 37.53 (953.3) 11.56 (293.6) 10.22 (259.6) 35.77 (908.6) 1.94 (49.3) 37 (17) JJDN250
KG Type 1 38.81 (985.8) 11.06 (280.9) 10.94 (277.9) 34.00 (863.6) 2.28 (57.9) 53 (24) 0.25, 0.50, 0.75, 1.50, 2, 2.50, 3, 3.50 SKDN400
2 300400
Type 3R 41.69 (1058.9) 11.75 (298.5) 14.06 (357.1) 39.90 (1013.5) 1.97 (50.0) 60 (27) 0.25, 0.50, 0.75, 2.50, 3, 3.50 RKDN400
Type 12 41.69 (1058.9) 11.75 (298.5) 14.06 (357.1) 39.90 (1013.5) 1.97 (50.0) 53 (24) JKDN400
2 LG Type 1 45.88 (1165.4) 14.31 (363.5) 12.38 (314.5) 46.56 (1182.6) 1.91 (48.5) 81 (37) 0.25, 0.50, 0.75, 3, 3.50, 4 SLDN600
450600
2 Type 3R 48.31 (1227.1) 14.91 (378.7) 15.50 (393.7) 46.56 (1182.6) 1.92 (48.8) 84 (38) 0.25, 0.50, 0.75, 3, 3.50, 4 RLDN600
Type 12 48.31 (1227.1) 14.91 (378.7) 15.50 (393.7) 46.56 (1182.6) 1.92 (48.8) 81 (37) JLDN600
2 NG
7001200
Type 1 61.22 (1555.0) 21.44 (544.6) 15.41 (391.4) 61.84 (1570.7) 1.97 (50.0) 178 (81) SNDN1200
Type 3R 63.59 (1615.2) 22.00 (558.8) 17.63 (447.8) 61.84 (1570.7) 1.97 (50.0) 175 (79) RNDN1200
2 Type 12 63.59 (1615.2) 22.00 (558.8) 17.63 (447.8) 61.84 (1570.7) 1.97 (50.0) 170 (77) JNDN1200
2
2 ON
D ON
A
2
D
A OFF OFF
D A
2
2 B
B
2 HFDDC 225 42 1 50 2 42 3 42 4
JGEDC 250 35 1 35 2 35 3
2 JGSDC 250 42 1 42 2 50 3
JGHDC 250 50 1 50 2 65 3
2 HJDDC 250 42 1 50 2 42 3
2
HKDDC 400 42 1 50 2 42 3
LGEDC 600 22 1 22 2 35 3
2 LGSDC 600 22 1 22 2 50 3
LGHDC 600 50 1 50 2 65 3
2 HLDDC 600 42 1 50 2 35 3
HLDDC 3 1200 42 1 50 2
2 HMDLDC 800 42 1 50 2 35 3
2 NBDC
RGHDC
1200
3000
42
42
1
1
50
50
2
2
50
65
3
3
2
IEC 60947-2 Interrupting Capacity Ratings
2 Circuit Breaker Maximum 125 Volts DC Poles in 250 Volts DC Poles in 600 Volts DC Poles in
Type Amperes Icu Ics Series Icu Ics Series Icu Ics Series
2 EGEDC 100 10 10 1 10 10 2
EGSDC 100 35 35 1 35 35 2
2 EGHDC 100 42 42 1 42 42 2
2 JGEDC 250 22 22 1 22 22 2
JGSDC 250 22 22 1 22 22 2
2 JGHDC 250 42 42 1 42 42 2
HJDDC 250 20 10 3
2 LGEDC 600 22 22 1 22 22 2
2
LGSDC 600 22 22 1 22 22 2
LGHDC 600 42 42 1 42 42 2
2 HLDDC 600 20 10 3
HMDLDC 800 20 10 3
2 Notes
1 DC ratings apply to substantially non-inductive circuits. Time constants per UL 489.
2 2 EGEDC through HMDLDC have been tested up to 300 Vdc to allow for battery charging voltages. 750 Vdc is common in transportation applications.
HFDDC, four-pole 750 Vdc is available up to 150 A maximum. 300 Vdc and 750 Vdc are not UL 489 listed voltage ratings.
2 3 Four-pole frame with two-poles connected in parallel.
See Page V4-T2-361 for series connection diagrams. Use NEC rated cable to connect/short poles in series as shown.
2
2
2
2
2
2
JGHDC = Series GJ (250 A max.) 040 = 40 A FFG = Fixed thermal, fixed magnetic trip unit, with terminals
HJDDC = Series CJ (250 A max.) 045 = 45 A FFW = Fixed thermal, fixed magnetic trip unit, without terminals
HKDDC = Series CK (400 A max.) 050 = 50 A FAG = Fixed thermal, adjustable magnetic trip unit, with terminals
LGEDC = Series GL (600 A max.)
LGSDC = Series GL (600 A max.)
060 = 60 A
070 = 70 A
FAW = Fixed thermal, adjustable magnetic trip unit, without terminals
KSG = Molded case switch, with terminals 2
LGHDC = Series GL (600 A max.) 080 = 80 A KSW = Molded case switch, without terminals
HLDDC = Series CL (1200 A max.)
HMDLDC = Series CM (800 A max.)
090 = 90 A
100 = 100 A
2
2
NBDC = NB (1200 A max.) 110 = 110 A
RGHDC = Series GR (3000 A max.) 125 = 125 A
150 = 150 A
175 = 175 A
200 = 200 A 2
225 = 225 A
250 = 250 A
300 = 300 A
2
2
350 = 350 A
400 = 400 A
450 = 450 A
500 = 500 A
600 = 600 A 2
700 = 700 A
800 = 800 A
900 = 900 A
2
1000 = 1000 A
1200 = 1200 A 2
1600 = 1600 A
2000 = 2000 A
2500 = 2500 A 2
3000 = 3000 A
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
Type EGEDC DC Circuit Breakers Type EGHDC DC Circuit Breakers
2 Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 35 kAIC at 500 Vdc Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 65 kAIC at 500 Vdc
Complete Circuit Breaker Complete Circuit Breaker Complete Circuit Breaker Complete Circuit Breaker
2 Maximum
Continuous with Terminals without Terminals
Maximum
Continuous with Terminals without Terminals
Ampere Rating Catalog Catalog Ampere Rating Catalog Catalog
2 at 40 C Number Number at 40 C Number Number
25 EGEDC3025FFG EGEDC3025FFW 25 EGHDC3025FFG EGHDC3025FFW
2 30 EGEDC3030FFG EGEDC3030FFW 30 EGHDC3030FFG EGHDC3030FFW
35 EGEDC3035FFG EGEDC3035FFW 35 EGHDC3035FFG EGHDC3035FFW
2 40 EGEDC3040FFG EGEDC3040FFW 40 EGHDC3040FFG EGHDC3040FFW
2 45
50
EGEDC3045FFG
EGEDC3050FFG
EGEDC3045FFW
EGEDC3050FFW
45
50
EGHDC3045FFG
EGHDC3050FFG
EGHDC3045FFW
EGHDC3050FFW
2
90 EGEDC3090FFG EGEDC3090FFW 90 EGHDC3090FFG EGHDC3090FFW
100 EGEDC3100FFG EGEDC3100FFW 100 EGHDC3100FFG EGHDC3100FFW
2 40 EGSDC3040FFG EGSDC3040FFW
45 EGSDC3045FFG EGSDC3045FFW
2 50 EGSDC3050FFG EGSDC3050FFW
60 EGSDC3060FFG EGSDC3060FFW
2 70 EGSDC3070FFG EGSDC3070FFW
2
80 EGSDC3080FFG EGSDC3080FFW
90 EGSDC3090FFG EGSDC3090FFW
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
100 JGSDC3100FAG JGSDC3250NN JT3100FA T250FJ
125 JGSDC3125FAG JGSDC3250NN JT3125FA T250FJ
2
Type JGHDC DC Circuit Breakers
2 JGHDC3250NN
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 65 kAIC at 600 Vdc
Complete Circuit Breaker Thermal-Magnetic Standard
2 Maximum
Continuous Breaker Frame Only 1 Trip Unit Terminals
Ampere Rating Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
2 at 40 C Number Number Number Number
70 JGHDC3070FAG JGHDC3250NN JT3070FA T250FJ
2 90 JGHDC3090FAG JGHDC3250NN JT3090FA T250FJ
100 JGHDC3100FAG JGHDC3250NN JT3100FA T250FJ
2 125 JGHDC3125FAG JGHDC3250NN JT3125FA T250FJ
2
Type HJDDC DC Circuit Breakers
2 HJDDC3250
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 42 kAIC at 600 Vdc
Circuit Breaker Thermal-Magnetic Standard
2 Maximum
Continuous Frame Only 1 Trip Unit Terminals
Ampere Rating Catalog Catalog Catalog
2 at 40 C Number Number Number
70 HJDDC3250F JT3070T TA250KB
2 90 HJDDC3250F JT3090T TA250KB
100 HJDDC3250F JT3100T TA250KB
2 125 HJDDC3250F JT3125T TA250KB
2 Note
1 For complete breaker, order individual frame, trip unit and terminals for field installation.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
350 LGHDC3350FAG LGHDC3630NN LT3350FA TA350LK
400 LGHDC3400FAG LGHDC3630NN LT3400FA TA350LK
2 300
350
HLDDC3600F
HLDDC3600F
LT3300T
LT3350T
TA602LD
TA602LD
2 600 HLDDC20600
700 HLDDC20700
2 800 HLDDC20800
2 900
1000
HLDDC20900
HLDDC21000
2 1200 HLDDC21200
Notes
2 1 For complete breaker, order individual frame, trip unit and terminals for field installation.
2 Three-pole kit.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 HFDDC 20
100
Steel
Steel
Cu/Al
Cu/Al
1410 (1)
141/0 (1)
2.54 (1)
2.550 (1)
3
3
3T20FB
3T100FB
2 HJDDC
HKDDC
250
225
Aluminum
Aluminum
Cu/Al
Cu/Al
4350 kcmil (1)
3350 kcmil (1)
25185 (1)
35185 (1)
1
1
TA250KB
TA300K
2
1200 Aluminum Cu/Al 4/0500 kcmil (4) 120240 (4) 1 TA1200NB1
2 Maximum
Continuous
With Line and Load Terminals Without Line and Load Terminals
2
250 65 3 JGKDC3250KSG JGKDC3250KSW
250 42 3 HJDDC3250K HJDDC3250KW
2 400 35
65
3
3
HKDDC3400K
LGKDC3400KSG
HKDDC3400KW
LGKDC3400KSW
2 600 65
35
3
3
LGKDC3630KSG
HLDDC3600K
LGKDC3630KSW
HLDDC3600WK
2
1 Four-pole frame with two-pole connected in parallel.
Notes
1 F-Frame circuit breakers are factory sealed. Underwriters Laboratories requires that internal accessories be installed at the factory. Internal accessories are UL listed for factory installation
2
under E7819. Where local codes and standards permit and UL listing is not required, internal accessories can be field installed. Accessory installation should be done before the circuit breaker
is mounted and connected. 2
2 Right-pole mounted.
One accessory can be mounted per pole, per breaker. Factory installation of accessories is available. Contact Eaton for assistance with part number configuration. 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Jumpers
2 Jumpers must be ordered separately. Priced individually.
2 HFDDC Frame
Maximum Catalog
2 Description Amperes Number
Single copper jumper 60 DC1F060 1
2 100 DC1F100 1
2 125 DC1F125 1
225 DC1F225 1
2
Description Amperes Number
Single aluminum jumper 250 DC1JG250A 1
2
Description Amperes Number
Single copper jumper 400 DC1K400 1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
2
2
1 Poles in series connection is customer supplied. Use rated cable per NEC.
2 For grounded systems, all poles in series must be connected on non-grounded terminal, with load connected to grounded terminal.
2
2
Dimensions
2 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
2 DC Breaker Dimensions
2 Frame
Number
of Poles Width Height Depth
2
JGEDC, JGSDC, JGHDC 3 4.13 (104.9) 7.00 (177.8) 3.57 (90.7)
HJDDC 2, 3 4.13 (105.0) 10.00 (254.0) 4.06 (103.1)
2 NBDC
RGHDC
3
3
8.25 (209.6)
15.50 (393.7)
16.00 (406.4)
16.00 (406.4)
5.50 (139.7)
9.75 (247.7)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
connection
Both options UL 489B
the PV modules to the commercial and utility scale PV systems. This solution 2
combiner or the inverter, applications. does not require jumpers
listed for solar photovoltaic
circuit protection
while also behaving as
a disconnect. PVGard 600 Vdc Per-Pole Lineup
with the breaker/switch to 2
be a UL 489B listed device,
50 C calibration
2
2
KD PVS Frame KD PVS Frame, 400 A Maximum, 600 Vdc Per Pole, 3 kA 1
Note
1 Terminals not included with frames.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 Catalog number includes breaker frame and trip unit. Order terminals separately. See Page V4-T2-369.
2
FD PV Frame, 100 A Maximum, 1000 Vdc, 3 kA 1
2 FD PV Frame
80% Rated 100% Rated
2 Current Rating Amperes Poles in Series Trip Unit Catalog Number Catalog Number
30 4 Fixed thermal, fixed magnetic FDPV4030W CFDPV4030W
2 40 4 Fixed thermal, fixed magnetic FDPV4040W CFDPV4040W
2 50
60
4
4
Fixed thermal, fixed magnetic
Fixed thermal, fixed magnetic
FDPV4050W
FDPV4060W
CFDPV4050W
CFDPV4060W
2
100 4 Fixed thermal, fixed magnetic FDPV4100W CFDPV4100W
2
LG PV Frame, 400 A Maximum, 1000 Vdc, 5 kA 1
2 LG PV Frame
80% Rated 100% Rated
2 Current Rating Amperes Poles in Series Trip Unit Catalog Number Catalog Number
250 4 Fixed thermal, fixed magnetic LGPV4250W CLGPV4250W
2 300 4 Fixed thermal, fixed magnetic LGPV4300W CLGPV4300W
350 4 Fixed thermal, fixed magnetic LGPV4350W CLGPV4350W
2 400 4 Fixed thermal, fixed magnetic LGPV4400W CLGPV4400W
2
2 MDL PV Frame MDL PV Frame, 600 A Maximum, 1000 Vdc, 7.5 kA 1
80% Rated 100% Rated
2 Current Rating Amperes Poles in Series Trip Unit Catalog Number Catalog Number
300 3 Fixed thermal, fixed magnetic MDLPV3300W CMDLPV3300W
2 350 3 Fixed thermal, fixed magnetic MDLPV3350W CMDLPV3350W
2 400
450
3
3
Fixed thermal, fixed magnetic
Fixed thermal, fixed magnetic
MDLPV3400W
MDLPV3450W
CMDLPV3400W
CMDLPV3450W
2
1 Terminals not included with frames.
External Accessories
applications requiring a
compact, high capacity
current protection. These
devices do not provide
2
Description Frame
Catalog
Number
disconnect. PVGard 1000 Vdc overload protection.
2
Imperial Base Mounting Hardware
0.164-32 x 1.5-inch pan-head steel screws and lockwashers FD PV BMH1
Molded Case Switches
Maximum Continuous Interrupting Poles in Catalog
2
2
0.250-20 x 1.5 inch pan-head steel screws and lockwashers KD PV BMH3 Ampere Rating at 50 C Capacity Vdc Series Number
KD PVS
1000 Vdc Maximum
JG PVS N/A
LG PV N/A
100
200
3000
5000
4
4
FDPV4100KW
KDPV4200KW
2
2
0.3125-18 x 1.25 inch filister-head steel screws and MDL PV BMH5
250 5000 4 KDPV4250KW
lockwashers and flat washers
350 5000 4 KDPV4350KW
Metric Base Mounting Hardware
M40.7 x 38 mm pan-head steel screws and lockwashers FD PV BMH1M
400
600
5000
7500
4
3
LGPV4400KSW
MDLPV3600KSW
2
M60.7 x 38 mm pan-head steel screws and lockwashers KD PV BMH3M
KD PVS Notes 2
JG PVS Included 1 1 Base mounting hardware is included with a circuit breaker or a molded case switch
LG PV IPB3
2 1 make/1 break
Auxiliary and Alarm Combo
B06 A1L1RPK B1 ALM1M1BJPKL B06 A1L3RPK B1 ALM1M1BJPK B06 A1L4RPK
2 1A-1B, 1 make/1 break C05 AAL1RPK B2w AUXALRMJPK C05 AAL3RPK B2 AUXALRMJPK C05 AA114RPK
2 Shunt Trip
12 Vdc S02 SNT1LP03K S4 SNT012CPK S42 SNT3P04K S4 SNT012CPK S02 SNT4LP03K
2
125 Vdc S10 SNT1LP12K S5 SNT125DPK S10 SNT3P11K S2 SNT120CPK S42 SNT4LP26K
250 Vdc S14 SNT1LP18K S14 SNT3P14K S14 SNT4LP14K
2 120 Vac S10 SNT1LP12K S2 SNT120CPK S10 SNT3P11K S2 SNT120CPK S10 SNT4LP11K
Undervoltage Release
2 12 Vdc U30 UVH1LP20K T02 UVH3LP20K U1 UVR012DPK T02 UVH4LP20K
24 Vdc U34 UVH1LP21K U2 UVR024CPK T02 UVH3LP21K U2 UVR024DPK T06 UVH4LP21K
2 48 Vdc U38 UVH1LP22K U4 UVR048DPK T10 UVH3LP22K U4 UVR048DPK T10 UVH4LP22K
2 60 Vdc
125 Vdc
U42
UVH1LP26K
U4
U6
UVR048DPK
UVR125DPK
T14
UVH3LP26K
U6
UVR125DPK
T14
UVH4LP26K
2 250 Vdc U46 UVH1LP28K U8 UVR250DPK T18 UVH3LP28K U8 UVR250DPK T18 UVH4LP28K
120 Vac U14 UVH1LP08K U5 UVR120APK U18 UVH3LP08K U5 UVR120APK U18 UVH4LP08K
2 Notes
1 Underwriters Laboratories requires that internal accessories for the FD PV be installed at the factory. Internal accessories are UL listed for factory installation
2 under E7819. Where local codes and standards permit and UL listing is not required, internal accessories can be field installed. Accessory installation should be
done before the circuit breaker is mounted and connected.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
LG PV
350
400
Copper
Aluminum
Cu
Cu/Al
3/0250 kcmil (2)
2500 kcmil (2)
95120 (2)
35240 (2)
4
4
4TA401K
4TA632LK
Contains interphase barriers
Includes 4P terminal cover
2
250 Copper Cu 2500 kcmil (1) 35240 (1) 1 T350LK 2
400 Copper Cu 2500 kcmil (2) 35240 (2) 4 4T632LK Includes 4P terminal cover
MDL PV 300 Aluminum Cu/Al 1500 kcmil (2) 1 TA700MA1 2
600 Aluminum Cu/Al 3/0400 kcmil (3) 1 TA800MA2
2
Endcap Kits
Breaker Frame Number of Poles Thread Type Thread Size Catalog Number
2
FD PV 4 Imperial 1032 KPEK14 2
4 Metric M5 KPEKM14
JG PVS 3 Imperial FJ3RTDK 2
3 Metric FJ3RTWK
KD PV 4 Imperial 0.31218 KPEK34
2
4 Metric M8 KPEKM34
2
KD PVS 3 Imperial KPEK3
3 Metric KPEKM3 2
LG PV 4 Imperial N/A
4 Metric M-10 L4RTWK 2
2
MDL PV 3 Imperial
3 Metric
Notes
1 Three terminals with terminal shield as a kit.
2
2 Three terminals with two interphase barriers as a kit.
2
2
2
2
Jumpers
2 Jumpers must be ordered separately. Priced individually.
2 FD PV Frame
Maximum Catalog
2 Description Amperes Number
Single copper jumper 60 DC1F060 1
2 100 DC1F100 1
2 125 DC1F125 1
225 DC1F225 1
2
Description Amperes Number
Single aluminum jumper 250 DC1JG250A 1
2
Description Amperes Number
Single copper jumper 400 DC1K400 1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Quick Reference PVGard Solar Circuit Breakers
1000 Vdc Poles-in-Series
2
PVGard 1000 Vdc Current Ratings by Frame
UL 489B Interrupting Capacity (kA) 1000 Vdc 2
Circuit
Breaker Type
Minimum
Amperes
Maximum
Amperes kA Rating
Poles in
Series 2
FD PV
KD PV
30
125
100
350
3
5
4
4
2
LG PV 250 400 5 4 2
MDL PV 300 600 7.5 3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
PVGard 600 Vdc Per-Pole Solar PV Circuit Breakers (100% and 80% Rated Frames)
2 JG PVS KD PVS
2 Environment
Design ambient temperature 50 C 50 C
2
Maximum current at 60 C, as % of rated current 93% 93%
Maximum current at 70 C, as % of rated current 85% 85%
Operating temperature range 20 C to +50 C 20 C to +50 C
2 Storage temperature range
Suitable for freeze temperatures to 40 C
20 C to +70 C
Option
20 C to +70 C
Option
2
Relative humidity 0 to 95% noncondensing 0 to 95% noncondensing
Suitable for reverse-feed applications Yes Yes
90
2
90
2
2 Connection diagrams
2 Terminations
Al/Cu wire TA250FJ: (1) #8350 kcmil TA300K: (1) #3350 kcmil
2
Weight in lbs 6.6 11.42
Notes
2
2
2
2
2
2
90
90
90
90
2
2
Connection diagrams 1 2
2
2
2
2
Load
Load
(A)
Terminations 2
Al/Cu wire #6300 kcmil (2) 3/0250 kcmil (2) #2500 kcmil (3) 3/0400 kcmil
Cu wire #44/0 (2) 3/0250 kcmil (2) #2500 kcmil (3) 3/0300 kcmil
2
Dimensions in inches (mm)
2
Height 6.00 (152.4) 10.13 (257.3) 10.13 (257.3) 16.00 (406.4)
Width
Depth
5.50 (139.7)
3.38 (85.9)
7.22 (183.4)
4.09 (103.9)
7.22 (183.4)
4.09 (103.9)
8.25 (209.5)
4.06 (103.1) 2
2
Weight in lbs 6 20 20 29
Notes
1 Suitable for use on ungrounded systems, or grounded systems that have one end of load (A) connected to grounded terminal, opposite poles in series connection.
2 Suitable for use on ungrounded systems only.
2
2
2
Dimensions
2 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
2 Number of
Circuits in
Frame a Frame Width Height Depth
2 JG PVS 3 4.13 (104.9) 7.00 (177.8) 3.44 (87.4)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Contents
2 E2 Mining Service Breakers
Description Page
2 Engine Generator Circuit Breakers. . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-343
Direct Current Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-349
2 PVGard Solar Circuit Breakers600 Vdc Per-Pole
and 1000 Vdc Poles-in-Series . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-363
2 E2 Mining Service Breakers
Catalog Number Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-378
2 Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-382
Accessories. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-393
2 Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-396
Classic Mining Breakers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-402
2 Add-On Ground Fault ProtectionType GFR . . . . . V4-T2-416
2
2
2
2 E2 Mining Service Breakers
2 Product Overview
600 Vac Mining Breaker 1000 Vac Mining Breaker
State-of-the-art E2 mining E2 electronic trip units are the Replacement Chart Replacement Chart
2 service breakers incorporate first to provide the mining
Classic Series C E2 Classic Series C E2M
the rigid specifications and industry with true rms
2 testing procedures developed
by a focus group led by
sensing, made possible by
the custom ASIC
FBM FDBM E2F HFM E2FM
HFBM FDM E2F JDCM E2JM
2 engineers from several
large coal companies and
microprocessor in each
electronic trip unit. HFDM (mag. only) E2F HKAM KDCM E2KM
Eaton design engineers. JDM E2J HLAM LDCM E2LM
2 Additionally, the performance E2 breakers are designed to
be physically and electrically KAM KDM E2K HLCM LDCM E2LM
of these breakers was proven
2 and verified during hundreds
of hours of field testing in
interchangeable with Classic
Mining Service Breakers and
KAMH
LAM
KDM
LDM
E2K
E2L
HMAM
HMCM
E2MM
E2MM
supersede Series C Mining
2 harsh mine environments.
Service Breakers. The table to LAMH LDM E2L HNBM E2NM
E2 mining breakers are the right outlines direct LCM LDM E2L HNBMH E2NM
2 available in 600 Vac, l000Y/ replacements. LCMH LDM E2L HNCM E2NM
577 Vac and 1200 Vac.
MAM E2M HLCLM E2NM
2 Interchangeable trip units can
be used on either 600 or 1000 MAMH E2M HPBM E2RM 1
2
are also available with a
BR01217001E E2 Mining Circuit Breaker Brochure
wide range of magnetic
pickup ranges. TC01217001E E2 Mining Circuit Breaker Time Current Curves
2 www.eaton.com/mining Mining and Metals
2 Note
1 E2R/E2RM is a new frame physically different than the HPBM. See DS29-170MS.
Notes
2
2
1 Two poles in series. DC rating applies to breakers with thermal-magnetic trip unit.
2
2
E2N
2 Current Ampere Blank = Standard mag.
E2R Voltage
Rating 2 = High mag.
Blank = 600 Vac max.
1002000
2 M = 1000Y/577 Vac max.
Trip Unit Function
M = 310+ Electronic Inst only
2
Number (magnetic only)
of Poles Blank = 310+ Electronic LSI
3 = Three-pole 38 = 310+ Electronic ALSI with
2 maintenance mode
2
E2 Mining Service 310+ Electronic Trip Unit
2 K E M 3 400 38 T 2 B20
2
Frame Size Optional Features
2 K Electronic Trip Magnetic Rating B20 1 = High load alarm
L E = Electronic trip Trip Unit (If Applicable)
2 M T Blank = Standard mag.
2 = High mag.
Voltage Current Ampere
2
(magnetic only)
Blank = 310+ Electronic LSI
Number
38 = 310+ Electronic ALSI with
of Poles
2 3 = Three-pole
maintenance mode
2 Notes
1 All N- and R-Frame breakers equipped with 310+ Electronic Trip Unit. No E suffix required.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 127 Vac
110 Vdc
2.4
1.6
2
120 Vac 1.13
127 Vac 1.25
2 120 Vac
127 Vac
2.1
2.4
2
125 Vdc 3.8
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
3 A150 A
2 E2F/E2FM
2
2 E2F/E2FM Sealed Breakers with Non-Interchangeable Trip UnitInclude Line/Load Terminals, Non-Electronic Trip Units 1
600 Vac Maximum 1000Y/ 577 Vac Maximum
2
250 Vdc 250 Vdc
35 kA at 480 Vac 10 kA at 1000 Vac
Three-Pole Three-Pole
2 Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Magnetic
Trip Range
Trip Unit Only
Catalog Number
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
2 Thermal-Magnetic
15 E2F3015
2 20 E2F3020 E2FM3020
25 E2F3025 E2FM3025
2 30 E2F3030
2 35 E2F3035
40 E2F3040 E2FM3040
2 45 E2F3045
50 E2F3050 E2FM3050
2 60 E2F3060 E2FM3060
2
70 E2F3070 E2FM3070
80 E2F3080 E2FM3080
2 90 E2F3090 E2FM3090
100 E2F3100 E2FM3100
2 125 E2F3125 E2FM3125
150 E2F3150 E2FM3150
2 Magnetic Only
2 3
7
930
2170
E2F003AM
E2F007CM
2 15 45150 E2F015EM
30 90300 E2F030HM
2 50150 E2F030EM
50 150500 E2F050KM E2FM050KM
2 66190 E2F050YM E2FM050YM
2 Note
1 For two-pole application, use outer poles.
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes 2
1 Frame only: E2J3250F.
2 Frame only: E2JM3250F.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
100 A400 A
2
E2K/E2KM/E2KW
2
2 E2K/E2KM Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Non-Electronic Trip Units
600 Vac Maximum 1000Y/ 577 Vac Maximum 1200 Vac Maximum
2 250 Vdc
35 kA at 480 Vac
250 Vdc
14 kA at 1000 Vac 10 kA at 1200 Vac
Three-Pole 1 Three-Pole 2 Three-Pole 34
2 Maximum Continuous Magnetic Trip Unit Only Complete Breaker Complete Breaker Complete Breaker
Ampere Rating at 40 C Trip Range Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
2 Thermal-Magnetic
2 100
125
5001000
6251250
E2K3100T
E2K3125T
E2K3100W
E2K3125W
E2KM3100W
E2KM3125W
E2KW3100W
E2KW3125W
2 250
11252250
12502500
E2K3225T
E2K3250T
E2K3225W
E2K3250W
E2KM3225W
E2KM3250W
E2KW3225W
E2KW3250W
2
400 20004000 E2K3400T E2K3400W E2KM3400W
Magnetic Only
2 10002000
11252250
E2K3400TMK
E2K3400TML
E2K3400MKW
E2K3400MLW
E2KM3400MKW
E2KM3400MLW
E2KW3350MKW
E2KW3350MLW
2 Notes
1 Frame only: E2K3400F.
2
2 Frame only: E2KM3400F.
3 1200 V breakers are sold as complete breakers only.
4 Maximum continuous ampere rating at 50 C.
2
2
2
2
2
2
160 A400 A
2
E2LME/E2LMZ (Series G)
2
2 Circuit Breakers
600 Vac Maximum 1000Y/ 577 Vac Maximum
2 250 Vdc
35 kA at 480 Vac
250 Vdc
14 kA at 1000 Vac
Three-Pole 1 Three-Pole 2
2 Maximum Continuous Magnetic Trip Unit Only Complete Breaker Complete Breaker
Ampere Rating at 40 C Trip Range Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
2 Magnetic Only
2 400
Interchangeable Electronic Trip Unit
36004400 LT3400KM E2LME3400KMW E2LMZ3400KMW
2 315
350
6303780
7004200
LT340031M
LT340031M
E2LME340031W
E2LME340031W
E2LMZ340031W
E2LMZ340031W
Notes
2 1 Frame only: E2LME3400NN.
2 Frame only: E2LMZ3400NN.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
300 A600 A
2
E2LE/E2LEM
2
2 E2LM Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Electronic Trip Units
600 Vac Maximum 1000Y/ 577 Vac Maximum
2 250 Vdc
35 kA at 480 Vac
250 Vdc
18 kA at 1000 Vac
Three-Pole 1 Three-Pole 2
2 Maximum Continuous Magnetic Trip Unit Only Complete Breaker Complete Breaker
Ampere Rating at 40 C Trip Range Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
2 310+ Electronic Instantaneous Only
2 400 5002500
10004000
LEM3400TM
LEM3400TM2
E2LE3400MW
E2LE3400M2W
E2LEM3400MW
E2LEM3400M2W
2 400 5002500
10004000
LEM3400T
LEM3400T2
E2LE3400W
E2LE34002W
E2LEM3400W
E2LEM34002W
2
300 5002500 LEM330038T E2LE330038W E2LEM330038W
350 5002500 LEM335038T E2LE335038W E2LEM335038W
2
1 Frame only: E2L3600F.
2 Frame only: E2LM3600F.
3 For High Load Alarm option (B20): E2LE360038B20W, LEM3600TB20.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
2
2
1 Frame only: E2M3800F.
2 Frame only: E2MM3800F.
3 1200 V breakers are sold as complete breakers only.
4 Maximum continuous ampere rating at 50 C.
2
Please see TD01217001E for detailed dimensions.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
800 A
2
E2ME/E2MEM
2
2 E2MN Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Electronic Trip Units
600 Vac Maximum 1000Y/ 577 Vac Maximum
2 250 Vdc
35 kA at 480 Vac
250 Vdc
18 kA at 1000 Vac
Three-Pole 1 Three-Pole 2
2 Maximum Continuous Magnetic Trip Unit Only Complete Breaker Complete Breaker
Ampere Rating at 40 C Trip Range Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
2 310+ Electronic Instantaneous Only
2 800 5002500
10004000
MEM3800TM
MEM3800TM2
E2ME3800MW
E2ME3800M2W
E2MEM3800MW
E2MEM3800M2W
Notes
2 1 Frame only: E2M3800F.
2 Frame only: E2MM3800F.
2
3 For High Load Alarm option (B20): E2ME380038B20W, MEM3800TB20.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 For High Load Alarm option (B20): E2N380038B20W.
2
Please see TD01217001E for detailed dimensions.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
1600 A2000 A
2
E2R/E2RM
2
2 E2RM Circuit Breakers with Electronic Trip Units
600 Vac Maximum 1000Y/ 577 Vac Maximum
2 250 Vdc
35 kA at 480 Vac
250 Vdc
18 kA at 1000 Vac
2
Three-Pole Three-Pole
Maximum Continuous Magnetic Trip Unit Only Complete Breaker Complete Breaker
Ampere Rating at 40 C Trip Range Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
2 310+ Electronic LSI 1
2 1600
2000
28 x In
28 x In
E2R316W
E2R320W
E2RM316W
E2RM320W
2 Notes
1 For High Load Alarm option (B20): E2R1638B20W.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
External Accessories
2
Padlockable Handle 2
Lock Hasp
Catalog 2
Breaker Type Number
E2F/E2FM PLK1 2
E2J/E2JM PLK3
E2K/E2KM/E2KW PLK3 2
E2LME/E2LMZ
E2L/E2LM/E2LW
LPHL
HLK4
2
E2M/E2MM/E2MW HLK4 2
E2N/E2NM PLK5
E2R/E2RM HLK6 2
2
2
2
Internal Accessories
2
Undervoltage Release 1
2 Breaker UVR Voltage Mounting Catalog Factory
Type Type Rating Location Number Modification Code
2 E2F/E2FM Handle reset 208240 Vac Left pole UVH1LP11K (thermal/magnetic only) 2 U18
2 Handle reset 110127 Vdc Left pole UVH1LP26K (thermal/magnetic only) 2 U42
E2J/E2JM Handle reset 110127 Vac Left pole UVH2LP08K 2 U18
2
120 volt handle reset with LED 120 Vac Left pole UVM3LP08KT 24 U68
Handle reset 110127 Vac Left pole UVH3LP08K 2 U18
2 E2R/E2RM 120 volt handle reset with LED 120 Vac Right pole UVM6RP08K 35 U58
Handle reset 110127 Vac Right pole UVH6RP08K 5 U49
2 Handle reset 208240 Vac Right pole UVH6RP11K 5 U53
2
Handle reset 110125 Vdc Right pole UVH6RP26K 5 T33
Notes
2 4 Terminal blocks.
5 RH only.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Dimensions
2 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
2
2 On
Off
2 B
2 B
ON/
2
2
OFF/
D
2 Front View Side View
2 A 4.13 (104.9)
B 6.00 (152.4)
2 C 3.38 (85.9)
D
D 3.50 (88.9)
2 Front View Side View
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Front View
D
Side View Front View
D
Side View
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 E2LME/E2LMZ
Circuit Breakers
E2L/E2LM/E2LW
Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Electronic Trip Units
2 A C A C
2
2
2
On/I On/I On/I On/I
2 B B
2
D D
2 Front View Side View Front View Side View
A C
Trip Units 2
A C
2
2
2
On/I On/I
2
B
Off/O Off/O
2
On/I On/I
2
Trip Unit May Be
Either Thermal/Magnetic
or Electronic
B 2
Off/O Off/O 2
Front View
D
Side View
2
2
Description Dimensions in Inches (mm)
A 8.25 (209.6) 2
2
B 10.75 (273.1)
C 4.06 (103.1)
D 4.38 (111.3)
D
2
Front View Side View
2
Description Dimensions in Inches (mm) 2
A 8.25 (209.6)
B 16.00 (406.4) 2
C
D
4.06 (103.1)
4.38 (111.3)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
B
2
2 On/I On/I
ON/I
B
2
2
Off/O Off/O
OFF/O
2
2
2
2 Front View
D
Side View
2 D
Front View Side View
2
Description Dimensions in Inches (mm) Description Dimensions in Inches (mm)
2 A 8.25 (209.6) A 8.25 (209.6)
2 B
C
16.00 (406.4)
4.06 (103.1)
B
C
16.00 (406.4)
5.50 (139.7)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
A C
2
2
2
2
2
B
2
2
2
2
D
Front View Side View 2
Description Dimensions in Inches (mm) 2
A
B
15.50 (393.7)
16.00 (406.4)
2
C 9.00 (228.6) 2
D 10.00 (254.0)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Contents
2 Description Page
2 Engine Generator Circuit Breakers. . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-343
Direct Current Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-349
2 PVGard Solar Circuit Breakers600 Vdc Per-Pole
and 1000 Vdc Poles-in-Series . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-363
2 E2 Mining Service Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-376
Classic Mining Breakers
2 Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-404
Accessories. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-409
2 Reference Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-411
Add-On Ground Fault ProtectionType GFR . . . . . V4-T2-416
2
2
2
2
2 Classic Mining Breakers
2 Product Overview
Classic mining service circuit installed Westinghouse
2 breakers continue to be equipment. To upgrade to the
manufactured and are current offering of E2 mining
2 primarily applied to achieve
an exact physical and
circuit breakers, consult the
cross reference information
2 electronic replacement of
previously Cutler-Hammer
on Page V4-T2-411.
2
AC Interrupting Capacity, Symmetrical Amperes
2 Breaker Type
2
60 Hz All Other 1000 Volt
AC Volts KAM LAM, MAM, NBM HKAM HLAM 2 Breakers 2
240 25,000 42,000
2 480 22,000 30,000
2 600
1
22,000 22,000
1000 10,000 12,000 14,000
2
2 Special DC Interrupting Capacity
Interrupting Capacity (Amperes) at 300330 Vdc
2 Single-Pole Two Poles in Series 4
Breaker Maximum
2 Type Ampere Rating 0.00.15 mH Inductance 3 0.150.5 mH Inductance 0.50.9 mH Inductance 2.4 mH Inductance
KAM 225 15,000 10,000 15,000 5000
2 LAM 400/600 15,000 10,000 15,000 5000
2 MAM
NBM
800
1200
15,000
15,000
10,000
10,000
15,000
15,000
5000
5000
2 Notes
1 Based on circuit power factor of 50% or greater.
2 2 HLAM must be rear stud connected. If front connected, interrupting capacity rating is 10,000 amperes.
3 Resistive circuit.
2
HMAM, NBM, HNBM
240/60 1.7 408
120/60 0.88 105.6
48 DC 8.0 384 2
Notes
1 Supplied for external customer mounting. 2
2 New design electrical reset UVR.
3 16,000 for Type MAM and HMAM. 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2 For reference only. Replace these frames with E2 Series. See Cross-Reference information beginning on Page V4-T2-411.
2 Classic Mining Service Circuit Breakers
2 Breaker
Type
Frame
Style Numbers 12 Poles Amperes
Trip
Type
Accessories
(Included in Frame)
Magnetic Trip Range,
Amperes 3
2
1291C26G03 3 225 TM UVR 4 300700
1291C26G04 3 225 TM UVR 4 5001000
2 LAM
1291C26G06
1291C32G01
3
2
225
400
M
TM
UVR 4
UVR 4
5001000
5001000
2 Notes
1 Terminals not included in style number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
1291C26G14 3 225 M UVR 2 300700
1291C26G15 3 225 M UVR 2 5001000
2
HLAM HLAM 5685D48G85 3 400 TM None 8001600
2 1291C32G07 3 400 TM UVR 2 8001600
2
2
2 HMAM HMAM 5685D48G84 3 600 TM None 15003000
2
2609D60G28 3 600 TM UVR 3 15003000
5685D48G83 3 800 TM None 20004000
2
2
2 HNAM HNBM 1227C36G12 3 1000 TM None 25005000
1229C37G19 3 1000 TM UVR 2 25005000
2 1227C36G11 3 1200 TM None 25005000
1229C37G20 3 1200 TM UVR 2 25005000
2 1229C37G18 3 1200 M UVR 2 25005000
2
2
2 Notes
2
1 The magnetic trip range does not change when rating plug is changed.
2 120 volt, 60 Hz electrical reset type.
3 Rated 120 volts, 60 Hz; undervoltage release is handle reset type.
2
2
2
2
2
2
400 3 2602D99G08
2
1200 3 2610D64G10
2
HLAM 400 3 1264C99G02 HNBM 1200 3 2610D64G13
LAM3600F 600 3 2603D48G07 2
LAMH3600F 600 3 2603D48G08
HLAM3600F 600 3 2603D48G09 2
2
Trip Units for Classic Mining Circuit Breakers
Thermal-Magnetic Magnetic Only
2
2
Breaker Conductor Magnetic Trip Range, Maximum Continuous Three-Pole3 Three-Pole
Type Size Amperes Amperes Style Numbers Style Numbers
HKAM #6
#4#3
150400
300700
180
225
5685D48G40
2609D99G22
2611D75G01
2
#4#1 5001000 225 5685D48G34 2611D75G02 2
HLAM #4#1 7501500 400 5685D48G97 2609D99G21
#2#2/0 8001600 400 5685D48G28 2611D75G03 2
HLAM600 #22/0 7501500 600 2609D99G20
2/0500 kcmil 15003000 600 2609D99G19
2
HMAM #2#2/0 7501500 600
2
2/0500 kcmil 15003000 600 5685D48G22 2611D75G04 4
#13/0 10002000 800 2
3/0500 kcmil 20004000 800 5685D48G16 2611D75G05
HNBM 2/0500 kcmil 15003000 1000 2
2
4/0500 kcmil 25005000 1000 5685D48G10
3/0500 kcmil 20004000 1200
4/0500 kcmil 25005000 1200 5685D48G04 2611D75G07
2
Notes
1 Frame modified for left-hand mounting of UVR attachment.
2 Frame modified for right-hand mounting of UVR attachment.
2
3 Three-pole trip units only are suitable for replacement in 1000 volt mining service circuit breakers.
4 800 amperes.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 Optional Al/Cu pressure terminals 225 TA225LA1 (1) #6350 kcmil Cu, or (1) #4350 kcmil Al
400 TA400LA1 (1) #4250 kcmil Al/Cu, plus (1) 3/0600 kcmil Al/Cu
2
MAM, HMAM, MAMH Standard copper pressure terminals 350 T350MA (1) #1600 kcmil Cu
600 T600MA1 (2) 2/0500 kcmil Cu
2
Long 656D565G02 4.03 (102.4) 456D983H09 1.00 (25.4)12 10.91 (277.1) 314C960G18
0.25 (6.4)0.50 (12.7) Short 656D565G01 1.34 (34.0) 456D983H07 MAM, HMAM, MAMH Breakers
Long 656D565G02 4.28 (108.7) 456D983H10 225 0.50 (12.7)13 3.66 (93.0) 314C960G01
2
400 0.75 (19.1)16 5.91 (150.1) 314C960G04
0.75 (19.1)16 8.41 (213.6) 314C960G05 2
0.75 (19.1)16 10.91 (277.1) 314C960G06
600 1.00 (25.4)12 5.91 (150.1) 314C960G07 2
1.00 (25.4)12
1.00 (25.4)12
8.41 (213.6)
10.91 (277.1)
314C960G08
314C960G09
2
800 1.13 (28.7)12 4.91 (124.7) 314C960G10 2
1.13 (28.7)12 8.41 (213.6) 314C960G11
1.13 (28.7)12 10.91 (277.1) 314C960G12 2
NBM, HNBM, NBMH Breakers
800 1.13 (28.7)12 5.50 (139.7) 623B222G01 2
1.13 (28.7)12
1.13 (28.7)12
8.00 (203.2)
10.50 (266.7)
623B222G02
623B222G03
2
1200 1.25 (31.8)12 5.50 (139.7) 373B375G04 2
1.25 (31.8)12 10.50 (266.7) 373B375G03
2
Line and Load Terminal Shields 5 2
Breaker Type Description Style Numbers
KAM Line terminals 1261C93G01
2
Load terminals 1262C46G01
2
LAM-400 Line terminals 1261C95G01
Load terminals 1262C48G01 2
MAM Line terminals 1261C97G01
Load terminals 1261C97G02 2
Notes
1 Not UL Iisted.
2
2
2 400 ampere LA studs of the same length have sufficient clearance; however, customer
connections may make it necessary to use a short stud adjacent to a long stud.
3 150, 300 and 400 ampere frames only.
4 This is a special stud that includes six contact nuts for use where bus contact nuts
must be used.
2
2
5 For breakers used with terminals and cable connections. Sold in packages of 10.
2
Right-Hand Mounting 120 Vac 2605D15G19
LAM, HLAM 120 Vac 4995D12G11 LAM, HLAM 480 Vac 2606D56G16
2 Left-Hand Mounting
KAM, HKAM 120 Vac 4995D10G01
120 Vac 2605D15G05
LAM, HLAM 480 Vac 2606D56G02
2 120 Vac 1 1228C76G03 240 Vac 2606D56G03
240 Vac 4995D10G03 120 Vac 2606D56G05
2 480 Vac 4995D10G04 MAM, HMAM, 480 Vac 2606D57G02
MAMH
2 240 Vac 2606D57G03
120 Vac 2606D57G05
2 NBM, HNBM,
NBMH
480 Vac 2606D58G02
240 Vac 2606D58G03
2 120 Vac 2606D58G05
2 Notes
1 Electrical reset UVR.
2
2 Auto reset type.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
E2 Cross-Reference, continued
2 Series C Mining Superseded by E2 Mining Series C Mining Superseded by E2 Mining
2 HFDM003AMLU62
HFDM007CM
E2F003AMLU62
E2F007CM
JDCM3225W
JDCM3250A5MW
E2JM3225W
E2JM3250MAW
2
HFDM015EMLU62 E2F015EMLU62 JDCM3250D5MW E2JM3250MDW
HFDM015EMU62 E2F015EMU62 JDCM3250D5MWA06 E2JM3250MDWA06
2
HFDM050KMLU62 E2F050KMLU62 JDCM3250G5MW E2JM3250MGW
HFDM050KMU62 E2F050KMU62 JDCM3250G5WA02D01 E2JM3250MGA02D01
2 HFDM100LMA02
HFDM100LMU62
E2F100LMA02
E2F100LMU62
JDCM3250L5MW
JDCM3250MW
E2JM3250MLW
E2JM3250MW
2
JDCM3070W E2JM3070W JDM3100W E2J3100W
JDCM3090W E2JM3090W JDM3125W E2J3125W
E2 Cross-Reference, continued
2 Series C Mining Superseded by E2 Mining Series C Mining Superseded by E2 Mining
2 KDCM3400N5WA02D07
KDCM3400R5MW
E2KM3400MNA02D07
E2KM3400MRW
KDM3400F
KDM3400F5MW
E2K3400F
E2K3400MFW
2
KDCMNA2D7 E2KM3400MNA02D07 KDM3400G5MW E2K3400MGW
KDM2400F E2K2400F KDM3400G5W E2K3400GW
2
KDM2400W5MWD07 E2K2400MWD07 KDM3400K5MW E2K3400MKW
KDM2400W5MWD07S10 E2K2400MWD07S10 KDM3400L5MW E2K3400MLW
2 KDM3150W
KDM3150WA06
E2K3150W
E2K3150WA06
KDM3400W5MW
KEM3100T
E2K3400MWW
KEM3100T
2
KDM3225WK38 E2KE3225MW KM2225TD5 E2K2225TD
KDM3250W E2K3250W KM2225TD5M E2K2400TMD
Contents
2 GFR Relay
Description Page
2 Engine Generator Circuit Breakers. . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-343
Direct Current Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-349
2 PVGard Solar Circuit Breakers600 Vdc Per-Pole
and 1000 Vdc Poles-in-Series . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-363
2 E2 Mining Service Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-376
Classic Mining Breakers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-402
2 Add-On Ground Fault ProtectionType GFR
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-417
2 Accessories. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-418
Technical Data and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-418
2
2
2
2
2 Add-On Ground Fault ProtectionType GFR
2 Product Description Standards and Certifications
A Type GFR ground fault The GFR devices are UL Eatons GFR ground fault
2 protection system, when Class I devices designed to relays, current sensors, test
properly installed on a protect electrical equipment panels and accessory devices
2 grounded electrical system,
will sense phase-to-ground
against extensive damage
from arcing ground faults.
are UL listed by Underwriters
Laboratories in accordance
2 fault currents. When the level
of fault current is in excess of A basic Type GFR ground
with their standard for ground
fault sensing and relaying
the pre-selected current fault protection system equipment, UL 1053, under
2 pickup and time delay consists of a ground fault
relay, a ground fault current
File E48381.
settings, the GFR relay will
2 initiate a trip action of a
disconnect device, which will
sensor and a disconnect
device equipped with a shunt
Note: Relays are also listed with
CSA under their file number
trip device. This disconnect 43357.
2 open the faulted circuit and
clear the fault. device can be a molded case
circuit breaker, a power
2 circuit breaker, a bolted
pressure switch or other
2 fusible disconnect device,
suitable for application with
2 UL Class I ground fault
sensing and relaying
equipment.
2 Note: Suitable for either surface
2
or semi-flush mounting.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Current Sensor
2
Typical Current Sensor
Window Size
in Inches (mm)
Catalog
Number
2
Used with Relays Rated 112 Amperes 2
5.50 (139.7) I.D. 1283C45G01
Used with Relays Rated 560 Amperes 2
2.50 (63.5) I.D. 179C768G01
5.50 (139.7) I.D. 1256C13G01
2
7.81 x 11.00 (198.4 x 279.4) Rect. 2 1257C88G04
2
3.31 x 24.94 (84.1 x 760.5) Rect. 2 1257C92G03
Used with Relays Rated 1001200 Amperes 2
2.50 (63.5) I.D. 179C768G02
5.50 (139.7) I.D. 1256C13G02 2
2
8.25 (209.6). I.D. 179C767G02
7.81 x 11.00 (198.4 x 279.4) Rect. 2 1257C88G03
9.94 x 16.94 (252.5 x 430.3) Rect. 2 1257C90G02
2
9.94 x 23.94 (252.5 x 608.1) Rect. 2 1257C91G02
15.94 x 19.94 (404.9 x 506.4) Rect. 2 1257C89G02 2
3.31 x 24.94 (84.1 x 633.5) Rect. 2 1257C92G04
6.75 x 29.64 (171.5 x 752.9) Rect. 2 1255C39G03 2
Notes
1 Suitable for either surface or semi-flush mounting.
2
2
2 One end removable for installation.
2
2
2
breaker.
2 Ground Fault Warning
Indicator
2 Catalog
Description Number
2 Manual reset 1234C67G01
Self-resetting 1234C67G02
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Contents
2 Handle Mechanisms
Description Page
2 Handle MechanismsSeries G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-419
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms
2 Product Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-421
Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-424
2 Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-425
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . . . V4-T2-427
2 Flex Shaft. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle MechanismsSeries C
V4-T2-428
2
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms. . V4-T2-433
Series C Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-437
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-439
2 Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . . . V4-T2-441
Flex Shaft. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-443
2 Handle Extension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-446
2
2
2 High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms
2 Product Description Features
The high-performance rotary In addition to its robust NEMA Type 1/3R/12 (IP54) Same handle can be used
2 handle mechanism uses a design features, the handle and NEMA Type 4/4X on multiple frame sizes,
simple, yet robust design mechanism has stand-off (IP65) ratings reducing the number of
2 to make installation and
operation easy. The external
support that allows for easy
operation with a gloved hand.
Black/Blue or Red/Yellow parts needed
external handle colors Red and yellow handles to
2 handles key functional
components are all metallic,
With a shallow profile, the
handle can easily be used in
Three shaft lengths6, 12
and 24 inches, which can
designate emergency
disconnecting means
ensuring reliability. The metal- applications where an internal
2 be cut to size to match All handle mechanisms can
on-metal interface between or double door is required. enclosure depth accept padlocks or multi-
the handle and shaft prevents hasp locks for added
2 The high-performance Conveniently packaged as
contaminant buildup that flexibility
could impede operation, external handle can accept kit containing handle, shaft
padlocks or multi-hasp locks. and mechanism Fast, easy installation
2 while UV and chemical agent
resistant materials protect The door is interlocked when Replacement parts are (see video on website for
the handle from heat and padlocked and cannot be available separately step-by-step instructions)
2 fading in direct sunlight, as bypassed. Metallic functional Standards and Certifications
well as chemicals that may components ensure
2 be introduced in harsh reliability
The mechanisms for EG, JG
and LG breakers have an
environments. Metal-on-metal interface internal handle that can be
2 between handle and shaft operated independent of
UV and chemical agent- door position, and locked-out
2 resistant materials protect to meet one of the key NFPA
the handle requirements (NFPA 79)
2 Shallow profile and UL 508A disconnect
requirements.
Compatible with both
2 Series C and Series G
molded case circuit
NEMA 1/3R/12, IP54
NEMA 4/4X, IP65
2 breakers and molded case
switch platforms
2
2
2
2
2
Shaft guide (68C6048G49) is optional and can be used with any high-performance handle listed above for greater alignment tolerance. 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 Description NEMA IP
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
2
2 S3 Red Handle S3 red handle, 1/3R/12 54 NGHMVD08R / 68C6043G02
10-inch shaft
2 4/4X 65 NGHMVD08RX / 68C6043G04
2
2 S4 Blue Handle S4 blue handle, 1/3R/12 54 NGHMVD08BT / 68C6043G05 RGHMVD08B / 68C6044G01
10-inch shaft
2 4/4X 65 NGHMVD08BTX / 68C6043G07 RGHMVD08BX / 68C6044G03
2
2
2 S4 Red Handle S4 red handle,
10-inch shaft
1/3R/12 54 NGHMVD08RT / 68C6043G06 RGHMVD08R / 68C6044G02
4/4X 65 NGHMVD08RTX / 68C6043G08 RGHMVD08RX / 68C6044G04
2
2
2
Note
2 Shaft guide (68C6048G49) is optional and can be used with any high-performance handle listed above for greater alignment tolerance.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Frame Width 6-Inch 10-Inch 12-Inch 24-Inch Only
EG 8 mm 66A6010G95 66A6010G96 66A6010G97 1498D66G17
JG 8 mm 66A6010G95 66A6010G96 66A6010G98 69D6025G17
2
LG 8 mm 66A6010G95 66A6010G96 66A6010G99 69D6051G30
NG 12 mm 66A6013H01 69D9101G30 2
RG 12 mm 66A6013H01 69D9101G31
2
Series G ComponentsHandles Only 2
2
Rating Type Handles Only
S01 S01 S2 S2 S3 S3 S4 S4
Frame NEMA IP Blue/Black Red/Yellow Blue/Black Red/Yellow Blue/Black Red/Yellow Blue/Black Red/Yellow
EG 1/3R/12 54 68C6048G41 68C6048G42 68C6048G01 68C6048G02 2
JG
4/4X
1/3R/12
65
54
68C6048G43
68C6048G41
68C6048G44
68C6048G42
68C6048G03
68C6048G01
68C6048G04
68C6048G02
2
4/4X 65 68C6048G43 68C6048G44 68C6048G03 68C6048G04 2
LG 1/3R/12 54 68C6048G01 68C6048G02 68C6048G05 68C6048G06
4/4X 65 68C6048G03 68C6048G04 68C6048G07 68C6048G08 2
NG 1/3R/12 54 68C6048G05 68C6048G06 68C6048G09 68C6048G10
4/4X 65 68C6048G07 68C6048G08 68C6048G11 68C6048G12
2
RG 1/3R/12 54 68C6048G09 68C6048G10
2
4/4X 65 68C6048G11 68C6048G12
2
Series G ComponentsOptional Caps 2
As an alternative to blue or red, a black, replaceable cap is available.
Catalog Number 2
S01 66A6032H01 Black handle cap HPHC0DGX
S2 66A6032H02 Black handle cap HPHC2DGX 2
S3 66A6032H03 Black handle cap HPHC3DGX
2
Series G Replacement Hardware
2
This kit provides replacement parts for
Series G high performance handle only. 2
Catalog Number
2
High-performance handle 66A6029G01
replacement parts kit
2
Notes
1 24-inch handle comes with support bracket.
Shaft guide (68C6048G49) is optional and can be used with any high-performance handle listed above for greater alignment tolerance.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Dimensions
2 Approximate Dimensions in mm (Inches)
2
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms
2 Front Operation
2
2
2
2
2
2
Type S3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 Type S4
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
2
2
1 Type 4/4X application requires special handle. See Ordering Information.
2 All rotary handle mechanisms include a handle Lock Off to prevent turning the breaker ON while in the OFF position.
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
2 Universal Rotary Universal Rotary Through-the-Door Handle Mechanisms
2 Handle
Color
UL
Rating
Shaft Length
in Inches (mm)
Complete
Catalog Number 1
2 EG-Frame
Black 1, 12 6.00 (152.4) EHMVD06B
2 JG-Frame
Black 1, 12 6.00 (152.4) FJHMVD06B
2
12.00 (304.8) FJHMVD12R
24.00 (609.6) FJHMVD24R
2 LG-Frame
Black 1, 12 6.00 (152.4) KLHMVD06B
2 12.00 (304.8) KLHMVD12B
24.00 (609.6) KLHMVD24B
2 Red 1, 12 6.00 (152.4) KLHMVD06R
2 12.00 (304.8)
24.00 (609.6)
KLHMVD12R
KLHMVD24R
2 NG-Frame
Black 1 6.00 (152.4) HMVD5B
2 RG-Frame
Black 1 9.00 (228.6) HMVD6B
2
2 Series G Rotary Series G Rotary Ordering Information
2 Shaft
Length
Complete
Catalog
Separate Catalog Number
Standard Breaker
Catalog Number
Inches (mm) Number 2 Handle 3 Mechanism 4 Shaft 5 IEC IP65 67 IEC IP66 67
2 N-Frame (ND and NG)
2 6.00 (152.4)
12.00 (304.8)
HM5R06
HM5R12
6648C22G21
6648C22G21
6648C23G08
6648C23G08
4217B37G08
4217B37G05
WHM5R06
WHM5R12
WHM5R06X
WHM5R12X
2
1 Complete catalog number includes handle, mechanism, shaft and mounting hardware.
2 Complete catalog number includes the standard handle, mechanism, shaft and support brace/bracket.
3 Handle is designed suitable for NEMA Types 1, 3R and 12 enclosures. Use style number 6648C22G03 for Type 4/4X handle or add X Suffix to complete catalog number.
2
5 Longer shafts,16-inch (406.4 mm) and 24-inch (609.6 mm), include an adjustable support extension.
6 IEC handle mechanism supplied with metric thread mounting hardware.
7 Complete catalog number includes a handle, mechanism and shaft.
2
2
2
Contents
2 Handle Mechanisms
Description Page
2 Handle MechanismsSeries G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-419
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms. . V4-T2-420
2 Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . . .
V4-T2-425
V4-T2-427
2 Flex Shaft
Product Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-429
2 Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-430
V4-T2-430
2 Handle MechanismsSeries C
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms. . V4-T2-433
Series C Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-437
2 Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-439
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . . . V4-T2-441
2 Flex Shaft. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-443
Handle Extension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-446
2
2
2 Flex Shaft
2 Product Description Standards and Certifications
Flex Shaft is UL listed under
2 Flange-Mounted Handle
Mechanisms
Flex Shaft comes preset from
the factory, requiring only
File E64983 and meets CSA
requirements.
2 Flange-mounted handle
mechanisms mount on the
minor field adjustments on
installation, which takes
flange of an enclosure door. about 10 minutesa
2 The Flex Shaft is an extra significant time savings
heavy-duty mechanism that compared to installation of
2 includes a flexible shaft in other types of flange handle
various lengths, 3 feet (0.9m) mechanisms. The Flex Shaft
2 through 10 feet (3m) for use
with various size enclosures.
mechanism also takes up less
interior enclosure space than
2 The Flex Shaft handle will
competitive designs, and the
handle fits standard flange
accept up to three padlock cutouts. Flex Shaft handle
2 shackles, each with a
maximum diameter of
can be remotely mounted
from breaker, where an
2 3/8 inches (9.5 mm). It can be
used with Type12 fabricated
operator can use it by
funneling the cable
enclosures. An optional
2 handle is available for Flex
through conduit.
Shaft that is suitable for use
2 with Type 4 environments.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Breaker
2 (0.6)
Catalog
3 (0.9)
Catalog
4 (1.2)
Catalog
5 (1.3)
Catalog
6 (1.8)
Catalog
2
2
Frame Number Number Number Number Number
EG EHMFS02 EHMFS03 EHMFS04 EHMFS05 EHMFS06
JG N/A JHMFS03 JHMFS04 JHMFS05 JHMFS06 2
LG N/A LHMFS04
NG N/A N/A F5S04C F5S05C F5S06C 2
RG N/A N/A F6S04 F6S05 F6S06
2
2
Flexible Shaft Length in Feet (m)
7 (2.1) 8 (2.4) 9 (2.7) 10 (3.1)
Breaker Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
Frame Number Number Number Number 2
EG EHMFS07 EHMFS08 EHMFS09 EHMFS10
JG JHMFS07 JHMFS08 JHMFS09 JHMFS10
2
LG
NG
LHMFS07
N/A
N/A
N/A
LHMFS10
F5S10C
2
RG N/A N/A N/A N/A 2
2
High-Performance
High-Performance Flex Shaft Flange Mounted Handle Mechanism 12
Flex Shaft Flexible Shaft Length in Feet (m) 2
2 (0.6) 3 (0.9) 4 (1.2) 5 (1.3) 6 (1.8)
Breaker
Frame
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
EG EGFS02HP EGFS03HP EGFS04HP EGFS05HP EGFS06HP 2
JG N/A JGFS03HP JGFS04HP JGFS05HP JGFS06HP
LG N/A N/A LGFS04HP N/A N/A 2
2
NG N/A N/A F5S04HP F5S05HP F5S06HP
RG N/A N/A F6S04HP F6S05HP F6S06HP
Notes
2
2
1 Three-pole only for EG-; three- and four-pole for JG- and LG-Frame.
2 EG-, JG- and LG-Frame can be left- or right-hand mounted.
2
2
2
Accessories
2
2
Handle Auxiliary SwitchEarly Break Design, Type 12 Safety Door Hardware for Flex Shaft
1A1B Contact for Flex Shaft (E- through R-Frame) 1
2
Breaker Catalog Catalog
Frame Number Number 2
2
EG AUX1EBFSEG C361KJ4
JG AUX1EBFSJG C361KJ6
2 LG AUX1EBFSLG C361KR
2
C361KJ6 6.00 (152.4)
C361KR Roller latch 3
2 Notes
1 Customer: Consult with box manufacturer for correct door hardware and any adapters
latching is required.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 Handle Extension
Handle extension is not
2 included with J, K, L, M and
N-Frame breakers. It must be
2 purchased separately.
Product Selection
2
Handle Mechanisms for Series C Frames
2
2 Kits Only (Kit Includes Shaft, Mechanism and Handle)GC/GD- and GMCP-Frame
Rating Type GC/GD-Frame GMCP-Frame
2 Catalog Catalog
Description NEMA IP Number Number
2 S01 Blue Handle S01 blue handle, 1/3R/12 54 GCHMVD12B / 68C6039G01 GMHMVD12B / 68C6039G05
12-inch shaft
4/4X 65 GCHMVD12BX / 68C6039G03 GMHMVD12BX / 68C6039G07
2
2 S01 Red Handle S01 red handle,
12-inch shaft
1/3R/12 54 GCHMVD12R / 68C6039G02 GMHMVD12R / 68C6039G06
4/4X 65 GCHMVD12RX / 68C6039G04 GMHMVD12RX / 68C6039G08
2
2
Separate Components for Series C Frames
2
2 Series C ComponentsShaft and Mechanism
Shaft Shaft Length Mechanism
2 Frame Width 6-Inch 10-Inch 12-Inch Only
GC/GD 6 mm 66A6013H02 GCHMVD / 2A92095G15
2 GMCP 6 mm 66A6013H02 GMHMVD / 2A92095G16
2
MDL 10 mm 66A6012G15 66A6012G16 1498D34G95
ND 12 mm 66A6013H01 69D9101G30
2 RD 12 mm 66A6013H01 69D9101G31
Note
2 Shaft guide (68C6048G49) is optional and can be used with any high-performance handle listed above for greater alignment tolerance.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
JD
4/4X
1/3R/12
65
54
68C6048G43
68C6048G44
68C6048G03
68C6048G01
68C6048G04
68C6048G02
2
4/4X 65 68C6048G03 68C6048G04 2
KD 1/3R/12 54 68C6048G01 68C6048G02
4/4X 65 68C6048G03 68C6048G04 2
2
LD 1/3R/12 54 68C6048G01 68C6048G02 68C6048G05 68C6048G06
4/4X 65 68C6048G03 68C6048G04 68C6048G07 68C6048G08
MDL 1/3R/12 54 68C6048G01 68C6048G02 68C6048G05 68C6048G06
2
4/4X 65 68C6048G03 68C6048G04 68C6048G07 68C6048G08
ND 1/3R/12 54 68C6048G05 68C6048G06 68C6048G09 68C6048G10 2
4/4X 65 68C6048G07 68C6048G08 68C6048G11 68C6048G12
RD 1/3R/12 54 68C6048G09 68C6048G10 2
2
4/4X 65 68C6048G11 68C6048G12
Note
Shaft guide (68C6048G49) is optional and can be used with any high-performance handle listed above for greater alignment tolerance.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Dimensions
2 Approximate Dimensions in mm (Inches)
2
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms
2 Front Operation
2
2
2
2
2
2
Type S3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 Type S4
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
Through-the-Door Handle Mechanisms
2
Series C Rotary Series C Rotary Ordering Information
2 Shaft Complete Separate Catalog Number Catalog Number
Length Catalog Standard Breaker
2 Inches (mm) Number 1 Handle 2 Mechanism 3 Shaft 4 IEC IP65 56 IEC IP66 56
F-Frame
2 6.00 (152.4) HM1R06 6648C22G25 6648C23G11 4217B37G08 WHM1R06 WHM1R06X
2 12.00 (304.8)
16.00 (406.4)
HM1R12
HM1R16
6648C22G25
6648C22G25
6648C23G11
6648C23G11
4217B37G05
4217B37G06
WHM1R12
WHM1R16
WHM1R12X
WHM1R16X
2
24.00 (609.6) HM3R24 6648C22G01 6648C23G25 4217B37G07 WHM3R24 WHM3R24X
L- and MDL-Frame
2 6.00 (152.4)
12.00 (304.8)
HM7R06
HM7R12
6648C22G21
6648C22G21
6648C23G17
6648C23G17
4217B37G08
4217B37G05
2 Notes
1 Complete catalog number includes the standard handle, mechanism, shaft and support brace/bracket.
2 2 Handle is designed suitable for NEMA Types 1, 3R and 12 enclosures. Use style number 6648C22G03 for Type 4/4X handle or add X Suffix to complete catalog number.
2
3 Breaker mechanism includes a shaft support bracket and its parts. Shaft is.50-inch (12.7 mm).
4 Longer shafts,16-inch (406.4 mm) and 24-inch (609.6 mm), include an adjustable support extension.
5 IEC handle mechanism supplied with metric thread mounting hardware.
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
2
2
1 Type 4/4X application requires special handle. See Ordering Information.
2 All rotary handle mechanisms include a handle Lock Off to prevent turning the breaker ON while in the OFF position.
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
Universal Rotary F-Frame
2
2 Universal Rotary Series C Universal Rotary 1
F-Frame Handle Shaft Length Complete
2 Color in Inches (mm) Catalog Number
G-Frame
2 Black 6.00 (152.4) GHMVD06B
2
12.00 (304.8) GHMVD12B
Red 6.00 (152.4) GHMVD06R
2 12.00 (304.8)
24.00 (609.6)
FHMVD12R
FHMVD24R
2 J-Frame
Black 6.00 (152.4) JHMVD06B
2 12.00 (304.8) JHMVD12B
2
Red 6.00 (152.4) JHMVD06R
12.00 (304.8) JHMVD12R
2 K-Frame
Black 6.00 (152.4) KHMVD06B
2 12.00 (304.8) KHMVD12B
Red 6.00 (152.4) KHMVD06R
2 12.00 (304.8) KHMVD12R
2
L-Frame
Black 6.00 (152.4) LHMVD06B
2 Note
1 Only available as complete handle mechanism. Parts not sold separately.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms
2
2 Euro IEC Direct
Black Handle
2 Catalog
Frame Number
2 F HMCC1B
J HMCC2B
2 K HMCC3B
2 L and M
N
HMCC4B
HMVD5B
2 R HMVD6B
2
G Direct 1
2 Black Handle Yellow Handle
With Shroud Without Shroud With Shroud Without Shroud
2 Frame
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
1 Suitable for use on two- or three-pole G-Frame.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
Handle Mechanisms
2
Flex Shaft 12
2 Flexible Shaft Length in Feet (m)
3 (0.9) 4 (1.2) 5 (1.5) 6 (1.8) 7 (2.1) 8 (2.4) 9 (2.7) 10 (3.0)
2 Breaker Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
Frame Number Number Number Number Number Number Number Number
2 G1 F0S03C F0S04C F0S05C F0S06C
F F1S03C F1S04C F1S05C F1S06C F1S07C F1S08C F1S09C F1S10C
2 F (dual) F1S03CD F1S04CD F1S05CD F1S06CD F1S07CD F1S08CD F1S09CD F1S10CD
2
MD, MDS (old) F7S04 F7S05 F7S06 F7S10C
2 Breaker
3 (0.9)
Catalog
4 (1.2)
Catalog
5 (1.3)
Catalog
6 (1.8)
Catalog
7 (2.1)
Catalog
8 (2.4)
Catalog
9 (2.7)
Catalog
10 (3.1)
Catalog
2
Frame Number Number Number Number Number Number Number Number
G F0S03HP F0S04HP F0S05HP F0S06HP N/A N/A N/A N/A
2 N
R
N/A
N/A
F5S04HP
F6S04HP
F5S05HP
F6S05HP
F5S06HP
F6S06HP
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
F5S10HP
N/A
2 Type C371
2 Operating
Operating Mechanism w/ 4-Inch Handle
For NEMA 112 For NEMA 4/4X
Mechanism Only 4 Enclosure Enclosure
2 Circuit Breaker or Frame
Variable Depth
Mounting Range Catalog Catalog Catalog
Motor Circuit Protector Size Min./Max. 23 Number Number Number
2 HMCP and Series CEHD, FDB, FD, FDC, HFD, ED 150 6.5016 (165.1406.4) C371E C371E1 C371E2
2
HMCP and Series CHJD, JD, JDB, JDC 250 6.5016.63 (165.1422.4) C371F C371F5 C371F6
HMCP and Series CDK, HKD, KD, KDB 400 6.5016.63 (165.1422.4) C371F C371F5 C371F6
2 Series CHLD, LD, LDC 600 8.5022 (215.9558.8) C371G C371G5 C371G6
Series C MD, MDS(No MDL) 800 8.7522 (222.3558.8) C371K C371K5 C371K6
2 Series CHND, ND, NDC 1200 9.7522 (247.7558.8) C371K C371K5 C371K6
2
Notes
1 Suitable for GC/GD MCCB; not suitable Type 4/4X handle mechanisms are available. When selecting the length of shaft,
for GMCP. Add Suffix X to complete catalog number. ensure minimum bending radius of 4 inches
2 2 For increased maximum allowable
2
Connecting Rods 1 2
Application Catalog Number
Disconnect switches (30, 60, 100, 200 A sizes) C371CS1 2
2
Circuit breakers (150, 250, 400 A sizes) C371CS1
Circuit breakers (600, 800, 1200 A sizes) C371CS2
Note 2
1 Increase maximum allowable depth by 5 inches (127 mm).
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Contents
2 Handle Extension
Description Page
2 Handle MechanismsSeries G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-419
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms. . V4-T2-420
2 Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . . .
V4-T2-425
V4-T2-427
2 Flex Shaft
Handle MechanismsSeries C
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms. . V4-T2-433
2 Series C Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-437
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . . . V4-T2-441
2 Flex Shaft. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-443
Product Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-444
2 Handle Extension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V4-T2-446
2
2
2
2 Handle Extension
2 Product Description
Suitable for use on two- or
2 three-pole G-Frame
Not included with J, K, L,
2 M and N-Frame breakers;
it must be purchased
2
separately
Included with R-Frame
2 breakers
2
Product Selection
2
Handle Extension 12
2 Handle Extension
Style
Frame Number
2 J, K HEX3
2 L, M HEX4
N HEX5
2 R HEX6
2
Notes
1 Handle extension is not included with J, K, L, M and N-Frame
breakers.
2
2
2
2
2
2